Yamaha HTR 7065 Owner's Manual

User Manual: Yamaha HTR-7065 Owner's Manual

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 161 [warning: Documents this large are best viewed by clicking the View PDF Link!]

AV Receiver
Owner’s Manual
English
Read the supplied booklet “Safety Brochure” before using the unit.
En 2
CONTENTS
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
FEATURES 6
What you can do with the unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Part names and functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Front panel (HTR-7065) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Front panel (HTR-6065) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Front display (indicators) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Rear panel (HTR-7065) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Rear panel (HTR-6065) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
PREPARATIONS 14
General setup procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
1 Placing speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
2 Connecting speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Connecting front speakers that support bi-amp connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Input/output jacks and cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
3 Connecting a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
4 Connecting playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Connecting audio devices (such as CD players) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Connecting to the jacks on the front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
5 Connecting the FM/AM antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
6 Connecting to a network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
7 Connecting other devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Connecting an external power amplifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Connecting recording devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Connecting a device that supports SCENE link playback (remote connection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
8 Connecting the power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
9 Selecting an on-screen menu language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
10 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) . . . . . . . . . 37
Measuring at one listening position (single measure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) (HTR-7065 only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Checking the measurement results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Warning messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
PLAYBACK 45
Basic playback procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Selecting an HDMI output jack (HTR-7065 only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch
(SCENE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Configuring scene assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Selecting the sound mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Enjoying unprocessed playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Enjoying compressed music with enhanced sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Enjoying surround sound with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Listening to FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Selecting a frequency for reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Registering favorite radio stations (presets) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
En 3
Radio Data System tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Operating the radio on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Playing back iPod music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Connecting an iPod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Playback of iPod content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Connecting a USB storage device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Playback of USB storage device contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Media sharing setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Playback of PC music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Listening to Internet radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Preparing Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Controlling Zone2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Viewing the current status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Switching information on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Viewing the status information on the TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Configuring playback settings for different playback sources
(Option menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Option menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
CONFIGURATIONS 81
Configuring input sources (Input menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Input menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Scene menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Configuring sound programs/surround decoders
(Sound Program menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Sound Program menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Configuring various functions (Setup menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Setup menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Speaker (Manual Setup) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94
Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Multi Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
ECO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) . . . . . . . . . 103
Types of information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) . . . . . . 105
ADVANCED SETUP menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Changing the speaker impedance setting (SP IMP.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MON.CHK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Restoring the default settings (INIT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Updating the firmware (UPDATE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Checking the firmware version (VERSION) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Controlling external devices with the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Registering the remote control code for a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Registering the remote control codes for playback devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Resetting remote control codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Updating the unit’s firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
En 4
APPENDIX 112
Frequently asked questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Power and system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
FM/AM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
USB and network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Error indications on the front display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Ideal speaker layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
Audio information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
HDMI and video information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Yamaha technologies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Video signal flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Information on HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
HDMI Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
HDMI signal compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Trademarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Accessories En 5
Accessories
Check that the following accessories are supplied with the product.
Remote control Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) (x2)
AM antenna FM antenna
*One of the above is supplied depending on the region of
purchase.
YPAO microphone CD-ROM (Owner’s Manual)
Easy Setup Guide Safety Brochure
Insert the batteries the right
way round.
Operating range of the remote control
Point the remote control at the remote control sensor on the unit and remain within the operating range
shown below.
The illustrations of the main unit and remote control used in this manual are of the HTR-7065, unless
otherwise specified.
Some features are not available in certain regions.
Due to product improvements, specifications and appearance are subject to change without notice.
This manual explains operations using the supplied remote control.
This manual describes all the “iPod”, “iPhone” and “iPad” as the “iPod”. “iPod” refers to “iPod”, “iPhone”
and “iPad”, unless otherwise specified.
indicates precautions for use of the unit and its feature limitations.
indicates supplementary explanations for better use.
30° 30°
Within
6 m (20 ft)
(HTR-7065) (HTR-6065)
30° 30°
FEATURES What you can do with the unit En 6
FEATURES
What you can do with the unit
AV receiver (the unit)
Speakers
BD/DVD player
HDMI Control
Audio/Video
The unit’s
remote control TV remote control
Audio
HDMI Control
Audio
Video
TV
Sequential operation of a TV,
AV receiver, and BD/DVD
player (HDMI Control)
.p.124
Change the input source
and favorite settings with
one touch (SCENE)
.p.46
Supports 2- to 7.1-channel (plus presence)
speaker system. Allows you to enjoy your favorite
acoustic spaces in various styles.
• Automatically optimizing the speaker
settings to suit your room (YPAO)
.p.37
• Reproducing stereo or multichannel
sounds with the sound fields like
actual movie theaters and concert halls
(CINEMA DSP)
.p.48
• Enjoying compressed music with
enhanced sound (Compressed Music
Enhancer)
.p.52
• Playing back music in multiple rooms
(multi-zone)
.p.72
Operating external
devices with the supplied
remote control
.p.108
iPod/iPhone/iPad
USB device
Audio
Network contents
Wide variety of supported content
• iPod/iPhone/iPad .p.58
•USB .p.62
• Media server (PC/NAS) .p.65
• Internet radio .p.68
•AirPlay .p.70
3D and 4K signals supported
FEATURES What you can do with the unit En 7
Full of useful functions!
Connecting various devices (p.28)
A number of HDMI jacks and various input/output jacks
on the unit allow you to connect video devices (such as
BD/DVD players), audio devices (such as CD players),
game consoles, camcorders, and other devices.
Playing back TV audio in surround sound
with a single HDMI cable connection
(Audio Return Channel: ARC) (p.23)
When using an ARC -compatible TV, you only need one
HDMI cable to enable video output to the TV, audio
input from the TV, and the transmission of HDMI Control
signals.
Creating 3-dimensional sound fields (p.48)
Connecting presence speakers allows you to create a
natural 3-dimensional sound field in your own room
(CINEMA DSP 3D). Even when no presence speakers
are connected, the Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS)
function produces 3D surround sound.
Listening to FM/AM radio (p.53)
The unit is equipped with a built-in FM/AM tuner. You
can register up to 40 favorite radio stations as presets.
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (p.51)
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the unit plays
back the selected source with the least circuitry, which
lets you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality.
Easy operation with a TV screen
You can navigate through different types of content
(such as iPod, USB, and network), view information, or
easily configure the settings using the on-screen menu.
Low power consumption
The ECO mode (power saving function) reduces the
unit’s power consumption (p.102).
BD/DVD
player
Game
console
Camcorder
Set-top box
TV
CD player
HDMI Control
TV audio
Video from
external device
Useful tips
The combination of video/audio input jacks does not
match an external device...
Use “Audio In” in the “Input” menu to change the
combination of video/audio input jacks so that it matches
the output jack(s) of your external device (p.29).
Video and audio are not synchronized...
Use “Lipsync” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the delay
between video and audio output (p.94).
I want to hear audio from the TV speakers...
Use “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu to select the
output destination of signals input into the unit (p.97).
Your TV speakers may be selected as an output
destination.
I want to change the on-screen menu language...
Use “Language” in the “Setup” menu to select a
language from English, Japanese, French, German,
Spanish, Russian and Chinese (p.36).
I want to update the firmware...
Use “UPDATE” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to
update the unit’s firmware (p.107). If the unit is
connected to the Internet, a message will be displayed
on the TV when a firmware update is available (p.111).
Many other settings are available that let you to
customize the unit. For details, see the following pages.
Input settings (p.81)
Scene settings (p.84)
Sound program and surround decoder settings (p.86)
Various function settings (p.89)
Information view (such as audio signal and video
signal) (p.104)
System settings (p.105)
FEATURES Part names and functions En 8
Front panel (HTR-7065)
1MAIN ZONE z key
Turns on/off (standby) the unit.
2Standby indicator
Lights up when the unit is in standby mode under any of the
following conditions.
HDMI Control is enabled (p.96)
Standby Through is enabled (p.97)
Network Standby is enabled (p.98)
An iPod is being charged (p.58)
3ZONE 2 key
Enables/disables the audio output to Zone2 (p.75).
4ZONE CONTROL key
Changes the zone (main zone or the Zone2) that is controlled
by the keys and knobs on the front panel (p.75).
5INFO key
Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.77).
6MEMORY key
Registers FM/AM radio stations as preset stations (p.54).
7PRESET keys
Select a preset FM/AM radio station (p.54).
8FM and AM keys
Switch between FM and AM (p.53).
9Front display
Displays information (p.10).
0Remote control sensor
Receives remote control signals (p.5).
ATUNING keys
Select the radio frequency (p.53).
BPURE DIRECT key
Enables/disables Pure Direct (p.51).
CINPUT knob
Selects an input source.
DPHONES jack
For connecting headphones.
EYPAO MIC jack
For connecting the supplied YPAO microphone (p.37).
FTONE CONTROL key
Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range
of output sounds (p.79).
GSCENE keys
Select the registered input source, sound program, and
various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when
it is in standby mode (p.46).
HPROGRAM keys
Select a sound program or a surround decoder (p.47).
ISTRAIGHT key
Enables/disables the straight decode mode (p.50).
JVIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack
For connecting a device, such as a camcorder and a game
console (p.31).
KUSB jack
For connecting a USB storage device (p.62) or an iPod
(p.58).
VIDEO jack
For inputting video when “USB” is selected as the input
source (p.58).
LVOLUME knob
Adjusts the volume.
Part names and functions
INFOZONE 2
ZONE CONTROL
MEMORY
PRESET
FM AM
TUNING
CONTROL
TV
BD
DVD
NET
RADIO
INPUT
SCENE
MAIN ZONE
PHONES
SILENT
CINEMA
STRAIGHT
VIDEO
PURE DIRECT
iPod/iPhone/iPad
5V 2.1A
HDMI IN
VIDEO
VOLUME
AUX US B
TONE
PROGRAM
YPAO MIC
:9 B2 34561 78 A
CLF
EDHIJKG
FEATURES Part names and functions En 9
Front panel (HTR-6065)
1MAIN ZONE z key
Turns on/off (standby) the unit.
2Standby indicator
Lights up when the unit is in standby mode under any of the
following conditions.
HDMI Control is enabled (p.96)
Standby Through is enabled (p.97)
Network Standby is enabled (p.98)
An iPod is being charged (p.58)
3YPAO MIC jack
For connecting the supplied YPAO microphone (p.37).
4ZONE 2 key
Enables/disables the audio output to Zone2 (p.75).
5Remote control sensor
Receives remote control signals (p.5).
6ZONE CONTROL key
Changes the zone (main zone or the Zone2) that is controlled
by the keys and knobs on the front panel (p.75).
7INFO key
Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.77).
8MEMORY key
Registers FM/AM radio stations as preset stations (p.54).
9PRESET keys
Select a preset FM/AM radio station (p.54).
0FM and AM keys
Switch between FM and AM (p.53).
AFront display
Displays information (p.10).
BTUNING keys
Select the radio frequency (p.53).
CPURE DIRECT key
Enables/disables Pure Direct (p.51).
DPHONES jack
For connecting headphones.
EINPUT keys
Select an input source.
FTONE CONTROL key
Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range
of output sounds (p.79).
GSCENE keys
Select the registered input source, sound program, and
various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when
it is in standby mode (p.46).
HPROGRAM keys
Select a sound program or a surround decoder (p.47).
ISTRAIGHT key
Enables/disables the straight decode mode (p.50).
JVIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack
For connecting a device, such as a camcorder and a game
console (p.31).
KUSB jack
For connecting a USB storage device (p.62) or an iPod
(p.58).
VIDEO jack
For inputting video when “USB” is selected as the input
source (p.58).
LVOLUME knob
Adjusts the volume.
INFOZONE 2
ZONE CONTROL
MEMORY
PRESET
FM AM
TUNING
CONTROL
TV
BD
DVD
NET
RADIO
SCENE
MAIN ZONE
PHONES
SILENT
CINEMA
STRAIGHT
VIDEO
PURE DIRECT
iPod/iPhone/iPad
5V 2.1A
HDMI IN
VIDEO
VOLUME
AUX US B
TONE
PROGRAM
YPAO MIC
INPUT
5A C3 46781 2 9:
DL
FHIJKEG
B
FEATURES Part names and functions En 10
Front display (indicators)
1HDMI
Lights up when HDMI signals are being input or output.
OUT1/OUT2 (HTR-7065 only)
Indicates the HDMI OUT jacks currently outputting an HDMI
signal
OUT (HTR-6065 only)
Lights up when HDMI signals are being output.
2CINEMA DSP
Lights up when CINEMA DSP (p.48) is working.
CINEMA DSP n
Lights up when CINEMA DSP 3D (p.50) is working.
3ENHANCER
Lights up when Compressed Music Enhancer (p.52) is
working.
4ADAPTIVE DRC
Lights up when Adaptive DRC (p.79) is working.
5STEREO
Lights up when the unit is receiving a stereo FM radio signal.
TUNED
Lights up when the unit is receiving an FM/AM radio station
signal.
6PARTY (HTR-7065 only)
Lights up when the unit is in the party mode. (p.76)
7SLEEP
Lights up when the sleep timer is on.
8ZONE2
Lights up when audio output to Zone2 is enabled (p.75).
9MUTE
Blinks when audio is muted.
0Volume indicator
Indicates the current volume.
ACursor indicators
Indicate the remote control cursor keys currently operational.
BInformation display
Displays the current status (such as input name and sound
mode name). You can switch the information by pressing
INFO (p.77).
CSpeaker indicators
Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output.
AFront speaker (L)
SFront speaker (R)
DCenter speaker
FSurround speaker (L)
GSurround speaker (R)
HSurround back speaker (L)
JSurround back speaker (R)
KSurround back speaker
ZPresence speaker (L)
XPresence speaker (R)
LSubwoofer
SW
C
LR
PL PR
SLSR
VOL.
MUTE
ENHANCER
ADAPTIVE DRC
STEREO
PARTY
3
2
TUNED
SLEEP
ZONE
SBL SBSBR
OUT 1 2
1 623 4 7 98:5
A AB C
FEATURES Part names and functions En 11
Rear panel (HTR-7065)
1DC OUT jack
For connecting to an optional accessory.
2NETWORK jack
For connecting to a network (p.32).
3HDMI OUT 1–2 jacks
For connecting to HDMI-compatible TVs and outputting
video/audio signals (p.23). When using ARC, TV audio signal
can also be input through the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
4ANTENNA jacks
For connecting to FM and AM antennas (p.32).
5HDMI 1–5 jacks
For connecting to HDMI-compatible playback devices and
inputting video/audio signals (p.28).
6SPEAKERS terminals
For connecting to speakers (p.19).
7Power cable
For connecting to an AC wall outlet (p.35).
8AV 1–6 jacks
For connecting to video/audio playback devices and
inputting video/audio signals (p.28).
9AV OUT jacks
For outputting video/audio to a recording device (such as a
VCR) (p.33).
0AUDIO 1–2 jacks
For connecting to audio playback devices and inputting
audio signals (p.31).
AMONITOR OUT jacks
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
For connecting to a TV that supports component video and
outputting video signals (p.27).
VIDEO jack
For connecting to a TV that supports composite video and
outputting video signals (p.27).
BREMOTE IN/OUT jacks
For connecting to a Yamaha product that supports SCENE
link playback (p.34) or for connecting to an infrared signal
receiver/emitter that allows you to operate the unit and other
devices from another room (p.74).
CTRIGGER OUT jack
For connecting to a device that supports the trigger function
(p.34).
DAUDIO OUT jacks
For outputting audio to a recording device (such as tape
deck) (p.33).
EZONE2 OUT jacks
For connecting to the external amplifier used in Zone2 and
for outputting audio (p.73).
FPRE OUT jacks
For connecting to a subwoofer with built-in amplifier or to an
external power amplifier (p.33).
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
PB
Y
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
PR
PB
Y
PR
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
SPEAKERS
12V
0.1A
: D E FC
6
AB9
31 2 5 7
4
8
* The area around the video/audio output jacks is
marked in white on the actual product to
prevent improper connections.
FEATURES Part names and functions En 12
Rear panel (HTR-6065)
1DC OUT jack
For connecting to an optional accessory.
2NETWORK jack
For connecting to a network (p.32).
3HDMI OUT jack
For connecting to an HDMI-compatible TV and outputting
video/audio signals (p.23). When using ARC, TV audio signal
can also be input through the HDMI OUT jack.
4ANTENNA jacks
For connecting to FM and AM antennas (p.32).
5HDMI 1–5 jacks
For connecting to HDMI-compatible playback devices and
inputting video/audio signals (p.28).
6SPEAKERS terminals
For connecting to speakers (p.19).
7Power cable
For connecting to an AC wall outlet (p.35).
8AV 1–6 jacks
For connecting to video/audio playback devices and
inputting video/audio signals (p.28).
9AV OUT jacks
For outputting video/audio to a recording device (such as a
VCR) (p.33).
0AUDIO 1–2 jacks
For connecting to audio playback devices and inputting
audio signals (p.31).
AMONITOR OUT jacks
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
For connecting to a TV that supports component video and
outputting video signals (p.27).
VIDEO jack
For connecting to a TV that supports composite video and
outputting video signals (p.27).
BREMOTE IN/OUT jacks
For connecting to a Yamaha product that supports SCENE
link playback (p.34) or for connecting to an infrared signal
receiver/emitter that allows you to operate the unit and other
devices from another room (p.74).
CTRIGGER OUT jack
For connecting to a device that supports the trigger function
(p.34).
DAUDIO OUT jacks
For outputting audio to a recording device (such as tape
deck) (p.33).
EZONE2 OUT jacks
For connecting to the external amplifier used in Zone2 and
for outputting audio (p.73).
FSUBWOOFER 1–2 jacks
For connecting to a subwoofer with built-in amplifier (p.33).
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
COMPONENT
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDI O
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
SUBWOOFER
2
1
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
SPEAKERS
12V
0.1A
EXTRA SP
: D E FC
6
AB9
31 2 5 7
4
8
* The area around the video/audio output jacks is
marked in white on the actual product to prevent
improper connections.
FEATURES Part names and functions En 13
Remote control
1Remote control signal transmitter
Transmits infrared signals.
2SOURCE z key
Turns on/off an external device.
SOURCE key
Sets the remote control to operate external devices (p.109).
This key lights up in green after pressed.
RECEIVER key
Sets the remote control to operate the unit (p.109). This key
lights up in orange after pressed.
RECEIVER z key
Turns on/off (standby) the unit.
3Input selection keys
Select an input source for playback.
HDMI 1–5 HDMI 1–5 jacks
V-AUX VIDEO AUX jack (on the front panel)
AV 16 AV 1–6 jacks
AUDIO 1–2 AUDIO 1–2 jacks
TUNER FM/AM radio
USB USB jack (on the front panel)
NET NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a
desired network source)
Changes the external device to be controlled
without switching the input source.
4MAIN/ZONE2 switch
Changes the zone (main zone or Zone2) that is controlled by
the remote control (p.75).
5SCENE keys
Select the registered input source, sound program, and
various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when
it is in standby mode (p.46).
6PROGRAM keys
Select a sound program (p.47).
7External device operation keys
Select menus for external devices (p.109).
8ON SCREEN key
Displays the on-screen menu on the TV.
9Menu operation keys
Cursor keys Select a menu or a parameter.
ENTER Confirms a selected item.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
0MODE key
Switches the iPod operation modes (p.60).
ARadio keys
Operate the FM/AM radio when “TUNER” is selected as the
input source (p.53).
BAND Switches between FM and AM radio
PRESET Select a preset station.
TUNING Select the radio frequency.
External device operation keys
Let you play back and perform other operations for external
devices when an input source other than “TUNER” is
selected (p.109).
BSound mode keys
Select a sound mode (p.47).
CINFO key
Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.77).
DSLEEP key
Switches the unit to standby mode automatically after a
specified period of time has elapsed (sleep timer). Press
repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off).
ENumeric keys
Let you enter numerical values, such as radio frequencies.
MEMORY key
Registers FM/AM radio stations as presets (p.54).
FTV operation keys
Let you select TV input and volume, and perform other TV
operations (p.108).
GHDMI OUT key (HTR-7065 only)
Selects HDMI OUT jacks to be used for video/audio output
(p.45).
HPARTY key (HTR-7065 only)
Turns on/off the party mode (p.76).
IVOLUME keys
Adjust the volume.
JMUTE key
Mutes the audio output.
KOPTION key
Displays the option menu (p.78).
LDISPLAY key
Displays status information on the TV (p.77).
MCODE SET key
Registers remote control codes of external devices on the
remote control (p.108).
To operate external devices with the remote control, register a
remote control code for each device before using (p.108).
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
H
J
G
K
L
M
1
3
2
5
4
6I
7
E
D
F
8
A
B
:
C
9
(HTR-7065)
PREPARATIONS General setup procedure En 14
PREPARATIONS
This completes all the preparations. Enjoy playing movies, music, radio and other content with the unit!
General setup procedure
1Placing speakers (p.15) Select the speaker layout for the number of speakers that you are using and place them in your room.
2Connecting speakers (p.19) Connect the speakers to the unit.
3Connecting a TV (p.23) Connect a TV to the unit.
4Connecting playback devices (p.28) Connect video devices (such as BD/DVD players) and audio devices (such as CD players) to the unit.
5Connecting the FM/AM antennas (p.32) Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit.
6Connecting to a network (p.32) Connect the unit to a network.
7Connecting other devices (p.33) Connect external devices, such as an external power amplifier (HTR-7065 only) and recording devices.
8Connecting the power cable (p.35) After all the connections are complete, plug in the power cable.
9Selecting an on-screen menu language
(p.36) Select the desired on-screen menu language (default: English).
10 Optimizing the speaker settings
automatically (YPAO) (p.37)
Optimize the speaker settings, such as volume balance and acoustic parameters, to suit your room
(YPAO).
PREPARATIONS Placing speakers En 15
Select the speaker layout for the number of speakers that you are using and place the speakers and subwoofer (with built-in amplifier) in your room. This section describes the
representative speaker layout examples.
For information on the ideal speaker layout, see “Ideal speaker layout” (p.119).
If you have seven speakers, use two of them as surround back speakers or presence speakers.
To reinforce the rear right/left sounds, use them as surround back speakers.
To create a natural 3-dimensional sound field, use them as presence speakers.
Two subwoofers connected to the unit output the same sounds.
1Placing speakers
Caution
Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the unit’s speaker impedance to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
For details, see “Setting the speaker impedance” (p.18).
Speaker type Abbr. Function
Speaker system (the number of channels)
7.1+2 7.1 7.1 6.1 5.1 4.1 3.1 2.1
Front (L) 1
Produce front right/left channel sounds (stereo sounds).
● ●●●●●●●
Front (R) 2● ●●●●●●●
Center 3Produces center channel sounds (such as movie dialogue and vocals). ●●● ●
Surround (L) 4Produce surround right/left channel sounds. Surround speakers also produce surround back channel sounds when
no surround back speakers are connected.
● ●●●●●
Surround (R) 5● ●●●●●
Surround back (L) 6
Produce surround back left/right channel sounds.
●●
Surround back (R) 7●●
Surround back 8Produces sounds mixed from surround back left/right channel sounds.
Presence (L) QProduce CINEMA DSP effect sounds. In combination with CINEMA DSP 3D (p.50), the presence speakers create a
natural 3-dimensional sound field in your room.
●●
Presence (R) W●●
Subwoofer 9Produces LFE (low-frequency effect) channel sounds and reinforces the bass parts of other channels.
This channel is counted as “0.1”. You can connect 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to the unit. ● ●●●●●●●
1Speaker placement 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Placing speakers En 16
7.1+2-channel system
The surround back speakers and presence speakers do not produce sounds simultaneously. The unit
automatically changes the speakers to be used, depending on the selected CINEMA DSP (p.48).
7.1-channel system (using presence speakers)
7.1-channel system (using surround back speakers)
6.1-channel system
45
12
39
67
QW
9
45
12
39
QW
45
12
39
67
45
12
39
8
1Speaker placement 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Placing speakers En 17
5.1-channel system
4.1-channel system
3.1-channel system
2.1-channel system
45
12
39
45
12
9
12
39
12
9
1Speaker placement 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Placing speakers En 18
Setting the speaker impedance
Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When connecting
6-ohm speakers, set the speaker impedance to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also
use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
1Before connecting speakers, connect the power cable to an AC wall
outlet.
2While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press
MAIN ZONE z.
3Check that “SP IMP.” is displayed on the front display.
4Press STRAIGHT to select “6 Ω MIN”.
5Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and remove the
power cable from the AC wall outlet.
You are now ready to connect the speakers.
MAIN ZONE z
STRAIGHT
SPIMP.8MIN
1Speaker placement 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting speakers En 19
Connect the speakers placed in your room to the unit.
The following diagrams provide connections for 7.1+2-,
7.1-, and 6.1-channel systems as examples. For other
systems, connect speakers while referring to the
connection diagram for the 6.1-channel system.
Cables required for connection
(commercially available)
Speaker cables (x the number of speakers)
Audio pin cable (two for connecting two subwoofers)
7.1+2-channel system 7.1-channel system
(using surround back speakers)
2Connecting speakers
Caution
Remove the unit’s power cable from an AC wall outlet and turn
off the subwoofer before connecting the speakers.
Ensure that the core wires of the speaker cable do not touch
one another or come into contact with the unit’s metal parts.
Doing so may damage the unit or the speakers. If the speaker
cables short circuit, “Check SP Wires” will appear on the front
display when the unit is turned on.
The illustrations of the unit (rear) used in this section are of the
HTR-7065.
+
+
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDI O
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
1
67
2
3
45
99
QW
The unit (rear)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDI O
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
1
67
2
3
45
9
The unit (rear)
1 2 Speaker connections 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting speakers En 20
7.1-channel system
(using presence speakers)
6.1-channel system
Connecting speaker cables
Speaker cables have two wires. One is for connecting
the negative (-) terminal of the unit and the speaker, and
the other is for the positive (+) terminal. If the wires are
colored to prevent confusion, connect the black wire to
the negative and the other wire to the positive terminal.
aRemove approximately 10 mm (3/8”) of insulation from
the ends of the speaker cable and twist the bare wires of
the cable firmly together.
bLoosen the speaker terminal.
cInsert the bare wires of the cable into the gap on the side
(upper right or bottom left) of the terminal.
dTighten the terminal.
Using a banana plug
(U.S.A. and Australia models only)
aTighten the speaker terminal.
bInsert a banana plug into the end of the terminal.
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDI O
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
12
3
45
9
QW
The unit (rear)
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDI O
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
12
3
45
9
8
The unit (rear)
When using only one surround back speaker, connect it
to the SINGLE jack (L side).
FRONT
aa
b
d
c
+ (red)
- (black)
a
b
Banana plug
1 2 Speaker connections 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting speakers En 21
Push-type speaker terminals
(HTR-6065 only)
aRemove approximately 10 mm (3/8”) of insulation from
the ends of the speaker cable, and twist the bare wires of
the cable firmly together.
bPress down the tab.
cInsert the bare wires of the cable into the hole in the
terminal.
dRelease the tab.
Connecting the subwoofer
Use an audio pin cable to connect the subwoofer.
Connecting front speakers that
support bi-amp connections
When using front speakers that support bi-amp
connections, connect them to the FRONT jacks and
SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP jacks.
To enable the bi-amp function, set “Power Amp Assign”
(p.91) in the “Setup” menu to “5ch BI-AMP” after
connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet.
E
2/
PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
aa b
c
d+ (red)
- (black)
Audio pin cable
12
3
45
9
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDI O
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
The unit (rear)
Caution
Before making bi-amp connections, remove any brackets or
cables that connect a woofer with a tweeter. Refer to the
instruction manual of the speakers for details. If you are not
making bi-amp connections, make sure that the brackets or
cables are connected before connecting the speaker cables.
Surround back speakers cannot be used during bi-amp
connections.
1 2 Speaker connections 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Input/output jacks and cables En 22
Video/audio jacks
HDMI jacks
Transmit digital video and digital sound through a single
jack. Use an HDMI cable.
Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. We recommend using
a cable less than 5.0 m (16.4 ft) long to prevent signal quality
degradation.
To connect a device that has a DVI jack, an HDMI/DVI-D cable is
required.
The unit’s HDMI jacks support the HDMI Control, Audio Return
Channel (ARC), and 3D and 4K video transmission features.
Use high speed HDMI cables to enjoy 3D or 4K videos.
Video jacks
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
Transmit video signals separated into three
components: luminance (Y), chrominance blue (PB),
and chrominance red (PR). Use a component video
cable with three plugs.
VIDEO jacks
Transmit analog video signals. Use a video pin cable.
Audio jacks
OPTICAL jacks
Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital optical
cable. Remove the tip protector (if available) before
using the cable.
COAXIAL jacks
Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital coaxial
cable.
AUDIO jacks
Transmit analog stereo audio signals. Use a stereo pin
cable.
Input/output jacks and cables
HDMI cable
Component video cable
Video pin cable
AV 4
OPTICAL
( TV )
Digital optical cable
Digital coaxial cable
Stereo pin cable
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 23
Connect a TV to the unit so that video input to the unit can be output to the TV.
You can also enjoy playback of TV audio on the unit.
The connection method varies depending on the functions and video input jacks
available on your TV.
Refer to the instruction manual of the TV and choose a connection method.
Connection Method 1 (HDMI Control/ARC-compatible TV)
Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable.
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters
(p.96) in the “Setup” menu.
(HTR-7065 only)
HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, any video input to the unit can be output to the TV
(except some component video signals), regardless of the method used to connect the video device to the
unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.123).
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can navigate the iPod, USB storage device and
network sources, or configure the settings of the unit with the menu displayed on the TV.
(HTR-7065 only)
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.27).
3Connecting a TV
About HDMI Control
HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV
that supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit’s
power and volume with the TV’s remote control. You can also control playback
devices (such as an HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD player) connected to the
unit with an HDMI cable. For details, see “HDMI Control” (p.124).
About Audio Return Channel (ARC)
ARC allows audio signals to travel both ways under HDMI Control. If you connect a
TV that supports HDMI Control and ARC to the unit with a single HDMI cable, you
can output video/audio to the TV or input TV audio to the unit.
Does your TV support
Audio Return Channel (ARC)?
Does your TV support
HDMI Control?
Does your TV have an
HDMI input jack? Connection Method 3 (p.26)
Connection Method 2 (p.25)
Connection Method 1 (p.23)
Connection Method 4 (p.27)
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
HDMI
ARC
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI OUT (ARC) jack
HDMI input
(ARC-compatible)
The unit
(rear)
TV
1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 24
Necessary settings
To use HDMI Control and ARC, you need to configure the following settings.
For details on settings and operating your TV, refer to the instruction manual for the TV.
1
After connecting external devices (such as a TV and playback devices)
and the power cable to the unit, turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices.
2Configure the settings of the unit.
aCheck that ARC is enabled on the TV.
bSwitch the TV input to display video from the unit.
cPress ON SCREEN.
dUse the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
eUse the cursor keys (e/r) to select “HDMI”.
fUse the cursor keys (q/w) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER.
gUse the cursor keys to select “On”.
hPress ON SCREEN.
3Configure the settings for HDMI Control.
aEnable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (such as HDMI
Control-compatible BD/DVD player).
bTurn off the TV’s main power and then turn off the unit and playback devices.
cTurn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV’s main power.
dSwitch the TV input to display video from the unit.
eCheck the following.
On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not,
select the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
fCheck that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or
adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
This completes the necessary settings.
If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of the unit will be
automatically switched to “AV 4” and the TV audio will be played back on the unit.
If you cannot hear the TV’s audio, check that “ARC” (p.97) in the “Setup” menu is set to
“On”.
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and then plugging in again)
the devices. It may solve the problem.
If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on
the TV.
If the audio is interrupted while using ARC, set “ARC” (p.97) in the “Setup” menu to “Off” and use a digital
optical cable to input TV audio to the unit (p.25).
“AV 4” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks,
use “TV Audio Input” (p.96) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the
SCENE function (p.46), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
D
ISPL
A
Y
RETURN
O
PTIO
N
ON SCREEN
Cursor keys
ENTER
1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 25
Connection Method 2 (HDMI Control-compatible TV)
Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable and a digital optical cable.
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “HDMI” parameters
(p.96) in the “Setup” menu.
(HTR-7065 only)
HDMI Control is available only on the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, any video input to the unit can be output to the TV
(except some component video signals), regardless of the method used to connect the video device to the
unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.123).
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can navigate the iPod, USB storage device and
network sources, or configure the settings of the unit with the menu displayed on the TV.
(HTR-7065 only)
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.27).
Necessary settings
To use HDMI Control, you need to configure the following settings.
For details on settings and operating your TV, refer to the instruction manual for the TV.
1After connecting external devices (such as a TV and playback
devices) and power cable of the unit, turn on the unit, TV, and
playback devices.
2Configure the settings of the unit.
aSwitch the TV input to display video from the unit.
bPress ON SCREEN.
cUse the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
dUse the cursor keys (e/r) to select “HDMI”.
eUse the cursor keys (q/w) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER.
fUse the cursor keys to select “On”.
gPress ON SCREEN.
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
HDMI
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
HDMI
HDMI
AV 4
(TV)
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
OO
The unit
(rear)
HDMI OUT jack
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack Audio output
(digital optical)
TV
HDMI input
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
D
ISPL
A
Y
RETURN
O
PTIO
N
ON SCREEN
Cursor keys
ENTER
1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 26
3Configure the settings for HDMI Control.
aEnable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (such as a HDMI
Control-compatible BD/DVD player).
bTurn off the TV’s main power and then turn off the unit and playback devices.
cTurn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV.
dSwitch the TV input to display video from the unit.
eCheck the following.
On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not,
select the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
fCheck that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or
adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
This completes the necessary settings.
If you select a TV program with the TV remote control, the input source of the unit will be
automatically switched to “AV 4” and the TV audio will be played back on the unit.
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try turning off and on (or unplugging and then plugging in again)
the devices. It may solve the problem.
If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on
the TV.
“AV 4” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks or
if you want to use another input jack (other than OPTICAL) for connecting the TV, use “TV Audio Input”
(p.96) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.46),
you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
Connection Method 3 (TV with HDMI input jacks)
Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable and a digital optical cable.
If you switch the input source of the unit to “AV 4” using the AV 4 or SCENE(TV) keys,
the TV audio will be played back on the unit.
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, any video input to the unit can be output to the TV
(except some component video signals), regardless of the method used to connect the video device to the
unit. For details, see “Video signal flow” (p.123).
By connecting a TV to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can navigate the iPod, USB storage device and
network sources, or configure the settings of the unit with the menu displayed on the TV.
If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks or if you want to use another input jack (other
than OPTICAL) for connecting the TV, connect the TV to one of the AV 1–6 and AUDIO 1–2 jacks. To use
the SCENE function (p.46), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
(HTR-7065 only)
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.27).
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
HDMI
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
HDMI
HDMI
AV 4
(TV)
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
OO
The unit
(rear)
HDMI OUT jack
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack Audio output
(digital optical)
TV
HDMI input
1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting a TV En 27
Connection Method 4 (TV without HDMI input jacks)
When connecting any video device to the AV 1–2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks of the
unit, connect the TV to the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks.
When connecting any video device to the AV 3–6 (VIDEO) jacks or the front VIDEO jack
of the unit, connect the TV to the MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack.
If you select “AV 4” as the input source by pressing AV 4 or SCENE(TV), the TV audio
will be played back on the unit.
If you connect your TV to the unit with a cable other than HDMI, video input to the unit via HDMI cannot be
output to the TV.
Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI.
If you have connected any external device to the AV 4 jacks or if you want to use another input jack (other
than OPTICAL) for connecting the TV, connect the TV to one of the AV 1–6 and AUDIO 1–2 jacks. To use
the SCENE function (p.46), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE(TV).
COMPONENT VIDEO connection (with a component video cable)
VIDEO (composite video) connection (with a video pin cable)
Connecting another TV or a projector
(HTR-7065 only)
The unit has two HDMI output jacks. If you connect another TV or a projector to the unit
with an HDMI cable, you can switch the TV (or projector) to be used for watching
videos with the remote control (p.45).
HDMI Control is not available on the HDMI OUT 2 jack.
AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOT
TRIGGER O
U
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
HD
M
HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
AV 4
(TV)
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
P
R
P
B
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
OO
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
MONITOR O
U
P
B
Y
P
R
The unit (rear)
MONITOR OUT
(COMPONENT VIDEO)
jacks
Video input
(component video)
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack Audio output
(digital optical)
TV
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
RE
M
TRIGG
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
H
HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
1
2
VIDEO
VV
AV 4
(TV)
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
OO
VIDEO
N
ITOR OUT
The unit (rear)
MONITOR OUT
(VIDEO) jack Video input
(composite video)
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack Audio output
(digital optical)
TV
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
HDMI
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
HDMI
HDMI
The unit
(rear)
HDMI OUT 2 jack
HDMI input
Projector
TV (already connected)
TV
1 2 3 TV connection 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting playback devices En 28
The unit is equipped with a variety of input jacks including HDMI input jacks to allow
you to connect different types of playback devices. For information on how to connect
an iPod or a USB storage device, see the following pages.
Connecting an iPod (p.58)
Connecting a USB storage device (p.62)
Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players)
Connect video devices such as BD/DVD players, set-top boxes (STBs) and game
consoles to the unit. Depending on the video/audio output jacks available on your video
device, choose one of the following connections. We recommend using an HDMI
connection if the video device has an HDMI output jack.
If the combination of video/audio input jacks available on the unit does not match your video device, change
its combination according to the output jacks of your device (p.29).
HDMI connection
Connect a video device to the unit with an HDMI cable.
If you select the input source by pressing HDMI 1–5, the video/audio played back on
the video device will be output from the unit.
To watch videos input to the HDMI 1–5 jacks, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT jack of the
unit (p.23 to 26).
Component video connection
Connect a video device to the unit with a component video cable and an audio cable
(digital optical or digital coaxial). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on
the audio output jacks available on your video device.
If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–2, the video/audio played back on the
video device will be output from the unit.
The component video signals (other than 480i/576i signals) input to AV 1–2 jacks of the unit can be output
from the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks only. To watch those videos, you need to connect
your TV to the MONITOR OUT (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks of the unit (p.27).
4Connecting playback devices
FRONT CENTER
AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
K
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
0.1A
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
The unit (rear)
HDMI output
Video device
HDMI 1–5 jacks
Output jacks on video device
Input jacks on the unit
Video Audio
Component video
Digital optical AV 1 (COMPONENT VIDEO + OPTICAL)
Digital coaxial AV 2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + COAXIAL)
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
P
R
P
B
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
COMPONENT
AV1 AV2
VIDEO
OPTICAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
OO
CC
PR
PB
Y
PR
PB
Y
The unit (rear)
AV 1–2
(COMPONENT VIDEO)
jacks
Video output
(component video)
Video device
Audio output
(digital optical or digital coaxial)
AV 1 (OPTICAL) jack or
AV 2 (COAXIAL) jack
1 2 3 4 Playback device connections 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting playback devices En 29
Composite video connection
Connect a video device to the unit with a video pin cable and an audio cable (digital
coaxial, digital optical, or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit)
depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device.
If you select the input source by pressing AV 3–6, the video/audio played back on the
video device will be output from the unit.
To watch videos input to the AV 3–6 (VIDEO) jacks, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT jack
(p.23 to 26) or to the MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jack (p.27) of the unit.
Changing the combination of video/audio input jacks
If the combination of video/audio input jacks available on the unit does not match your
video device, change its combination according to the output jacks of your device. You
can connect a video device that has the following video/audio output jacks.
Necessary setting
For example, if you have connected a video device to AV 2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) and
AV 5 (AUDIO) jacks of the unit, change the combination setting as follows.
Output jacks on video device
Input jacks on the unit
Video Audio
Composite video
Digital coaxial AV 3 (VIDEO + COAXIAL)
Digital optical AV 4 (VIDEO + OPTICAL)
Analog stereo AV 5–6 (VIDEO + AUDIO)
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
AM
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
(TV)
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
VIDEO
VIDEO
CC
L
R
L
R
OO
V
V
The unit (rear)
AV 3–6 (VIDEO) jack
Video output
(composite video)
Video device
Audio output
(either digital optical,
digital coaxial, or analog stereo)
Any of AV 3 (COAXIAL) jack,
AV 4 (OPTICAL) jack,
AV 5–6 (AUDIO) jacks
Output jacks on video device Input jacks on the unit
Video Audio Video Audio
HDMI
Digital optical HDMI 1–5 AV 1 (OPTICAL)
AV 4 (OPTICAL)
Digital coaxial HDMI 1–5 AV 2–3 (COAXIAL)
Analog stereo HDMI 1–5 AV 5–6 (AUDIO)
AUDIO 1–2
Component video Analog stereo
AV 1–2
(COMPONENT
VIDEO)
AV 5–6 (AUDIO)
AUDIO 1–2
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5 AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
P
B
Y
P
R
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
A
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
A
M
AV 5
R
L
R
L
AUDIO
L
R
L
R
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
PR
PB
Y
PR
PB
Y
AV 2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks
Video output
(component video)
AV 5 (AUDIO) jacks
Video device
Audio output
(analog stereo)
The unit (rear)
1 2 3 4 Playback device connections 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting playback devices En 30
The following operation is available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI.
1After connecting external devices (such as a TV and playback
devices) and power cable of the unit, turn on the unit.
2Press AV 2 to select “AV 2” (video input jack to be used) as the input
source.
3Press ON SCREEN.
4Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
5Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “AV2” (video input jack to be
used) and press the cursor key (q).
6Use the cursor keys to select “Audio In” and press ENTER.
7Use the cursor keys to select “AV5” (audio input jack to be used).
8Press ON SCREEN.
This completes the necessary settings.
If you select “AV 2” as the input source by pressing AV 2, the video/audio played back
on the video device will be output from the unit.
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MENU
DISPLA
Y
RETURN
OPTION
TOP MENU
POP-UP/MEN
U
NET
TUNER
USB
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
12
12
34
N
TUNE
R
US
B
AV
A
UDI
O
5
6
5
V-AU
X
1
1
2
3
4
ON SCREEN
ENTER
AV 2
Cursor keys
1 2 3 4 Playback device connections 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting playback devices En 31
Connecting audio devices (such as CD players)
Connect audio devices such as CD players and MD players to the unit. Depending on
the audio output jacks available on your audio device, choose one of the following
connections.
If you select the input source by pressing AV 1–6 or AUDIO 1–2, the audio played back
on the audio device will be output from the unit.
Connecting to the jacks on the front panel
Use the VIDEO AUX jack to temporarily connect devices such as game consoles and
camcorders to the unit.
Use the USB jack to connect an iPod or a USB storage device. For details, see
“Connecting an iPod” (p.58) or “Connecting a USB storage device” (p.62).
Before making a connection, stop playback on the device and turn down the volume on
the unit.
If you select “V-AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX, the video/audio played
back on the device will be output from the unit.
To watch videos input to the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack, you need to connect your TV to the HDMI OUT
jack of the unit (p.23 to 26).
You need to prepare an HDMI cable that match the output jacks on your device.
When “USB” is selected as the input source, video signals input to the VIDEO jack are output from the
HDMI OUT and MONITOR OUT (VIDEO) jacks.
Audio output jacks on audio device Audio output jacks on the unit
Digital optical AV 1 (OPTICAL)
AV 4 (OPTICAL)
Digital coaxial AV 2–3 (COAXIAL)
Analog stereo AV 5–6 (AUDIO)
AUDIO 1–2
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
HD
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
CC
L
R
L
R
OO
Audio output
(either digital optical,
digital coaxial, or analog stereo)
AV 1–6 jacks
AUDIO 1–2 jacks
The unit (rear)
Audio device
CONTROL
TV
BD
DVD
NET
RADIO
PHONES
SILENT
CINEMA
STRAIGHT
VIDEO
iPod/iPhone/iPad
5V 2.1A
HDMI IN
VIDEO
AUX US B
TONE
PROGRAM
YPAO MIC
HDMI
Game console
Camcorder
The unit (front)
1 2 3 4 Playback device connections 5 6 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting the FM/AM antennas En 32
Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit.
Fix the end of the FM antenna to a wall, and place the AM antenna on a flat surface.
Assembling and connecting the AM antenna
Unwind only the length of cable needed from the AM antenna unit.
The wires of the AM antenna have no polarity.
Connect the unit to your router with a commercially-available STP network cable (CAT-5
or higher straight cable).
You can enjoy Internet radio or music files stored on media servers, such as PCs and
Network Attached Storage (NAS), on the unit.
If you are using a router that supports DHCP, you do not need to configure any network settings for the unit,
as the network parameters (such as the IP address) will be assigned automatically to it. You only need to
configure the network settings if your router does not support DHCP or if you want to configure the network
parameters manually (p.98).
You can check whether the network parameters (such as IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in
“Network” (p.104) in the “Information” menu.
Some security software installed on your PC or the firewall settings of network devices (such as a router)
may block the access of the unit to the network devices or the Internet. In these cases, configure the
security software or firewall settings appropriately.
Each server must be connected to the same subnet as the unit.
To use the service via the Internet, broadband connection is strongly recommended.
5Connecting the FM/AM antennas
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
SPE
A
12V
0.1A
FM antenna
AM antenna
The unit (rear)
Hold down Insert Release
6Connecting to a network
COMPONENT
AV 1AV 2AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
VIDEO
OPTICAL OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
P
B
Y
MONITOR OUT
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
NETWORKDC OUT
5V
0.5A
(NET)
HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
LAN
WAN
Network Attached Storage
(NAS)
Internet
Modem
Router
Network cable
PC
The unit (rear)
Mobile device
(such as iPod touch
and iPhone)
1 2 3 4 5 FM/AM antenna connections 6Network connections 7 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting other devices En 33
Connecting an external power amplifier
(HTR-7065 only)
When connecting an external power amplifier (pre-main amplifier) to enhance speaker
output, connect the input jacks of the power amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks of the unit.
The same channel signals are output from the PRE OUT jacks as from their
corresponding SPEAKERS terminals.
1FRONT jacks
Output front channel sounds.
2SURROUND jacks
Output surround channel sounds.
3SUR. BACK jacks
Output surround back channel sounds. When using only one external amplifier for the surround
back channel, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side).
4SUBWOOFER1–2 jacks
For connecting a subwoofer with built-in amplifier. When 2 subwoofers are connected, the same
sound is output from them.
5CENTER jack
Outputs center channel sounds.
Connecting recording devices
You can connect video/audio recording devices to the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks.
These jacks output analog video/audio signals selected as the input.
To copy video/audio from a video device, connect the video device to the AV 5–6 jacks of the unit.
To copy audio from an audio device, connect the audio device to the AV 5–6 jacks or AUDIO 1–2 jacks of
the unit.
Be sure to use the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks only for connecting recording devices.
7Connecting other devices
Caution
To prevent the generation of loud noises or abnormal sounds, make sure the followings before making
connections.
Remove the power cable of the unit and turn off the external power amplifier before connecting them.
When using the PRE OUT jacks, do not connect speakers to the corresponding SPEAKERS
terminals.
When using an external amplifier that does not have the volume control bypass, do not connect other
devices (except the unit) to the amplifier.
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
2
OUT
C
FM
AM
SPEAKERS
12V
0.1A
1 2 3 4 5
The unit (rear)
FRONT CENT
E
AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
0.1A
R
L
AUDIO
R
L
AUDIO
AUDIO
OUT
AV
OUT
VIDEO
VV
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
The unit (rear) AV OUT jacks
Video/audio input
Video recording
device
Audio recording
device
Audio inputAUDIO OUT jacks
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Other connections 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting other devices En 34
Connecting a device that supports
SCENE link playback (remote connection)
If you have a Yamaha product that supports SCENE control signal transmission, you
can operate it remotely by connecting it to the REMOTE OUT jack, using a monaural
mini-jack cable, and linking with the SCENE function (p.46).
If you connect a Yamaha product that supports the SCENE link playback function, to the REMOTE OUT
jack, you can remotely start playback on it by linking with a scene selection (p.46). To enable the SCENE
link playback function, specify the device type in “Device Control” (p.84) in the “Scene” menu.
You can also connect an infrared signal receiver/emitter to operate devices in the main zone from Zone2
(p.74).
Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function
The trigger function can control an external device in conjunction with operating the
unit (such as powering on/off and input selection). If you have a Yamaha subwoofer that
supports a system connection or a device with a trigger input jack, you can use the
trigger function by connecting the external device to the TRIGGER OUT jack.
You can configure the trigger function settings in “Trigger Output” (p.101) in the “Setup” menu.
FR
O
AV 3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
VIDEO
OPTICAL
(TV)
COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
K
HDMI 4HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
0.1A
IN
OUT
REMOTE
REMOTE
IN
The unit
(rear) REMOTE OUT jack
Yamaha product
(such as a DVD player)
Remote input
FRONT C
E
AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
2
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
0.1A
TRIGGER OUT
12V
0.1A
The unit (rear)
TRIGGER OUT jack
System connection
input
Yamaha subwoofer that
supports a system connection
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Other connections 8 9 10
PREPARATIONS Connecting the power cable En 35
After all the connections are complete, plug in the power cable.
8Connecting the power cable
CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
NE 2
O
UT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
D
MI 5
SPEAKERS
To an AC wall outlet
The unit (rear)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Power cable connection 910
PREPARATIONS Selecting an on-screen menu language En 36
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ON SCREEN
ENTER
RECEIVER z
Select the desired on-screen menu language from English
(default), Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian and
Chinese.
1Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit.
2Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display
video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
3Press ON SCREEN.
4Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press
ENTER.
5Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Language” and
the cursor keys (q/w) to select the desired
language.
6To confirm the setting, press ENTER.
7To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
The information on the front display is provided in English only.
9Selecting an on-screen menu language
123456789Language setting 10
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 37
The Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) function
detects speaker connections, measures the distances from them to
your listening position(s), and then automatically optimizes the
speaker settings, such as volume balance and acoustic
parameters, to suit your room.
Please note the following when using YPAO.
Use YPAO after connecting a TV and speakers to the unit.
During the measuring process, test tones are output at high volume. Ensure that
the test tones do not frighten small children. Also, refrain from using this function
at night when it may be a nuisance to others.
During the measuring process, you cannot adjust the volume.
During the measuring process, keep the room as quiet as possible.
Do not connect headphones.
1Press RECEIVER z to turn on the unit.
2Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display
video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
3Turn on the subwoofer and set the volume to half. If
the crossover frequency is adjustable, set it to
maximum.
If you are using bi-amp connection or Zone2 speakers, set “Power Amp
Assign” (p.91) in the “Setup” menu to the appropriate setting before starting
YPAO.
4Place the YPAO microphone at your listening
position (same height as your ears) and connect it
to the YPAO MIC jack on the front panel.
10 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO)
VOLUME HIGH CUT
CROSSOVER/
MIN MAXMIN MAX
9
YPAO MIC
9
12
3
45
The unit (front)
YPAO
microphone
Ear height
Place the YPAO microphone at
your listening position (same height
as your ears). We recommend the
use of a tripod as a microphone
stand. You can use the tripod
screws to stabilize the microphone.
YPAO MIC
jack
12345678910 Automatic speaker setup
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
RECEIVER z
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 38
The following screen appears on the TV.
(HTR-6065)
(HTR-7065)
(HTR-6065)
This completes the preparations.
See “Measuring at one listening position (single measure)”
(p.39) to start the measurement.
(HTR-7065)
Proceed to Step 5.
To cancel the operation, disconnect the YPAO microphone before starting
the measurement.
5(HTR-7065 only) If desired, change the measuring
method (multi/single).
aUse the cursor keys to select “Multi Position” and press ENTER.
bUse the cursor keys to select a setting and then press ENTER.
Settings
If you perform the multi measure, the speaker settings will be optimized for you to
enjoy surround sound in a wider space.
If you perform the multi measure, first place the YPAO microphone at the listening
position you will be seated most frequently.
Yes
Select this option if you will have several listening
positions or if you want others to enjoy surround sound.
You can take measurements at up to 8 different
positions in the room. The speaker settings will be
optimized to suit the area defined by those positions
(multi measure).
No (default)
Select this option if your listening position will always be
fixed. Take the measurements at only one position. The
speaker settings will be optimized to suit that position
(single measure).
12345678910 Automatic speaker setup
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 39
This completes the preparations. See the following page to start the
measurement.
When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”:
“Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)
(HTR-7065 only)” (p.40)
When “Multi Position” is set to “No”:
“Measuring at one listening position (single measure)” (p.39)
Measuring at one listening position
(single measure)
Follow the procedure below for measurement.
Do not stand between the speakers and the YPAO microphone during the
measurement process (about 3 minutes).
Move to the corner of the room or leave the room.
1To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to
select “Measure” and press ENTER.
The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER
again to start the measurement immediately.
To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN.
The following screen appears on the TV when the
measurement finishes.
If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1)
appears, see “Error messages” (p.43) or “Warning messages” (p.44).
To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see
“Checking the measurement results” (p.41).
a b
a
a
b
c
d
e
c
d
de
bac
Multi measure
(5 listening positions)
Multi measure
(2 listening positions + front/back)
Multi measure
(1 listening position + front/back/left/right)
Single measure
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
12345678910 Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 40
2Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and
press ENTER.
3To save the measurement results, use the cursor
keys (e/r) to select “SAVE” and press ENTER.
The adjusted speaker settings are applied.
To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”.
4Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit.
This completes optimization of the speaker settings.
Measuring at multiple listening positions
(multi measure) (HTR-7065 only)
When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”, follow the procedure below for
measurement.
Do not stand between the speakers and the YPAO microphone during the
measurement process. It takes about 10 minutes to measure 8 listening positions.
Move to the corner of the room or leave the room.
If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears,
see “Error messages” (p.43) or “Warning messages” (p.44).
1To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to
select “Measure” and press ENTER.
The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER
again to start the measurement immediately.
To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN.
The following screen appears on the TV when the
measurement at the first position finishes.
2Move the YPAO microphone to the next listening
position and press ENTER.
Repeat step 2 until measurements at all listening positions
(up to 8) have been taken.
Caution
The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere
where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on
top of AV equipment).
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
12345678910 Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 41
3When the measurements at the positions you want
to measure are completed, use the cursor keys to
select “CANCEL” and press ENTER.
When you have taken measurements at 8 listening
positions, the following screen appears automatically.
To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see
“Checking the measurement results” (p.41).
4Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and
press ENTER.
5To save the measurement result, use the cursor
keys to select “SAVE” and press ENTER.
The adjusted speaker settings are applied.
To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”.
6Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit.
This completes optimization of the speaker settings.
Checking the measurement results
You can check the YPAO measurement results.
1After the measurement, use the cursor keys to
select “Result” and press ENTER.
You can also select “Result” from “Auto Setup” (p.89) in the “Setup” menu,
which displays the previous measurement results.
The following screen appears.
1Measurement result items
2Measurement result details
3The number of measured positions (when multi
measure is performed) * HTR-7065 only
Caution
The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere
where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on
top of AV equipment).
12
3
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
12345678910 Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 42
2Use the cursor keys to select an item
A speaker with a problem is indicated with a message enclosed in a red box.
3To finish checking the results and return to the
previous screen, press RETURN.
Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments
When the speaker settings you have configured manually are not
suitable, follow the procedure below to discard the manual settings
and reload the previous YPAO adjustments.
1In the “Setup” menu, select “Speaker”, “Auto
Setup”, and then “Result” (p.88).
2Use the cursor keys to select “Setup Reload” and
press ENTER.
3To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Wiring
Polarity of each speaker
Normal: The speaker cable is connected with the
correct polarity (+/-).
Reverse: The speaker cable may be connected with the
reverse polarity (+/-).
Size
Size of each speaker (cross-over frequency of the
subwoofer)
Large: The speaker can reproduce low-frequency
signals effectively.
Small: The speaker cannot reproduce low-frequency
signals effectively.
Distance Distance from the listening position to each speaker
Level Output level adjustment for each speaker
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ON SCREEN
ENTER
RETURN
12345678910 Automatic speaker setup
Cursor keys
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 43
Error messages
If any error message is displayed during the measurement, resolve the problem and perform YPAO again.
Error message Cause Remedy
E-1: No Front SP Front speakers are not detected.
Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then check the speaker connections.E-2: No Sur. SP One of the surround speakers cannot be detected.
E-3: No F.PRNS SP One of the presence speakers cannot be detected.
E-4: SBR SBL A surround back speaker is connected to the R side only. When using only one surround back speaker, you need to connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Follow the
on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speaker.
E-5: Noisy The noise is too loud. Keep the room quiet and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If you select
“PROCEED”, YPAO takes the measurement again and ignores any noise detected.
E-6: Check Sur. Surround back speakers are connected, but no surround
speakers are connected
Surround speakers need to be connected in order to use surround back speakers. Follow the on-screen
instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speakers.
E-7: No MIC The YPAO microphone has been removed. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the
measurement again.
E-8: No Signal The YPAO microphone cannot detect test tones.
Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the
measurement again. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service
center.
E-9: User Cancel The measurement has been canceled. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. To cancel the measurement, select “EXIT”.
E-10: Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off and on the unit. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact
the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
12345678910 Automatic speaker setup
PREPARATIONS Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) En 44
Warning messages
If a warning message is displayed after the measurement, you can still save the measurement results by following on-screen instructions.
However, we recommend you perform YPAO again in order to use the unit with the optimal speaker settings.
Warning message Cause Remedy
W-1: Out of Phase A speaker cable may be connected with the reverse polarity
(+/-).
Select “Wiring” in “Result” (p.41) and check the cable connections (+/-) of the speaker identified by
“Reverse”. If the speaker is connected incorrectly, turn off the unit and then reconnect the speaker cable.
Depending on the type of speakers or room environment, this message may appear even if the speakers are
connected correctly.
W-2: Over Distance A speaker is placed more than 24 m (80 ft) from the listening
position.
Select “Distance” in “Result” (p.41) and move the speaker identified by “>24.0m (>80.0ft)” within 24 m (80 ft)
of the listening position.
W-3: Level Error There are significant volume differences between the
speakers.
Check the usage environment and cable connections (+/-) of each speaker, and the volume of the
subwoofer. We recommend using the same speakers or speakers with specifications that are as similar as
possible.
12345678910 Automatic speaker setup
PLAYBACK Basic playback procedure En 45
PLAYBACK
1Turn on the external devices (such as a TV or
BD/DVD player) connected to the unit.
2Use the input selection keys to select an input
source.
3Start playback on the external device or select a
radio station.
Refer to the instruction manual for the external device.
For details on the following operations, see the
corresponding pages.
Listening to FM/AM radio (p.53)
Playing back iPod music (p.58)
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device
(p.62)
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)
(p.65)
Listening to Internet radio (p.68)
Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay)
(p.70)
4Press VOLUME to adjust the volume.
To mute the audio output, press MUTE. Press MUTE again to unmute.
To adjust the treble/bass settings, use the “Option” menu or TONE
CONTROL on the front panel (p.79).
On-screen input selection
aPress ON SCREEN.
bUse the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
cUse the cursor keys to select the desired input source and
press ENTER.
Selecting an HDMI output jack
(HTR-7065 only)
1Press HDMI OUT to select an HDMI OUT jack.
Each time you press the key, the HDMI OUT jack to be
used for signal output changes.
You can also select an HDMI output jack by selecting a scene (p.46).
When “HDMI OUT 1+2” is selected, the unit outputs video signals at the highest
resolution supported by both TVs (or projectors) connected to the unit. (For
example, if you have connected a 1080p TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack and a 720p
TV to the HDMI OUT 2 jack, the unit outputs 720p video signals.)
Basic playback procedure
HDMI OUT 1+2 Outputs the same signal at both the HDMI OUT 1
and HDMI OUT 2 jacks.
HDMI OUT 1 Output the signals at the selected HDMI OUT jack.
HDMI OUT 2
HDMI OUT Off Does not output the signals at the HDMI OUT jacks.
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SLSR
SBL SBR
HDMIOUT1+2
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
P
R
OG
RA
M
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
PARTY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ON SCREEN
ENTER
VOLUME
MUTE
HDMI OUT
Cursor keys
Input selection keys
PLAYBACK Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) En 46
The SCENE function allows you to select the assigned input source,
sound program, Compressed Music Enhancer on/off, and HDMI
output jack (HTR-7065 only) with just one touch.
1Press SCENE.
The input source and settings registered to the
corresponding scene are selected. The unit turns on
automatically when it is in standby mode.
By default, the following settings are registered for each scene.
Configuring scene assignments
1Perform the following operations to prepare the
settings you want to assign to a scene.
Select an input source (p.45)
Select a sound program (p.47)
Enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.52)
(HTR-7065 only)
Selecting an HDMI output jack (p.45)
2Hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET
Complete” appears on the front display.
3If you want to control the corresponding playback
device after selecting the scene, hold down the
corresponding SCENE key and input selection key
together for more than 3 seconds.
Once the setting is completed successfully, SOURCE blinks twice.
If you have not registered the remote control code of the playback device yet, see
“Registering the remote control codes for playback devices” (p.109) to register it.
You can also configure scene assignments in the “Scene” menu (p.83).
The SCENE link playback function allows you to start playback of an external
device connected to the unit via HDMI or of a Yamaha product connected to the
REMOTE OUT jack. To enable SCENE link playback, specify the device type in
“Device Control” (p.84) in the “Scene” menu.
Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE)
SCENE Input Sound
program
Compressed
Music Enhancer
HDMI output jack
(HTR-7065 only)
BD/DVD HDMI 1 MOVIE
(Sci-Fi) Off HDMI OUT 1+2
TV AV 4 STRAIGHT On HDMI OUT 1+2
NET NET
RADIO
MUSIC
(7ch Stereo) On HDMI OUT 1+2
RADIO TUNER MUSIC
(7ch Stereo) On HDMI OUT 1+2
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
SETComplete
VOL.
SBL SBR
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
M
O
DE
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
SCENE
SOURCE
Input selection keys
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 47
The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs and
surround decoders that allow you to enjoy playback sources with
your favorite sound mode (such as sound field effect or stereo
playback).
Selecting a sound program suitable for movies (p.48)
Press MOVIE repeatedly.
Selecting a sound program suitable for music or stereo
playback (p.49)
Press MUSIC repeatedly.
Selecting a surround decoder (p.51)
Press SUR.DECODE repeatedly.
Switching to the straight decode mode (p.50)
Press STRAIGHT.
Switching to the Pure Direct mode (p.51)
Press PURE DIRECT.
Enable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.52)
Press ENHANCER.
On-screen sound program/surround decoder selection
aPress ON SCREEN.
bUse the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press
ENTER.
cUse the cursor keys to select a sound program/surround
decoder and press ENTER.
You can also switch the sound programs and surround decoder by pressing
PROGRAM.
You can change the settings of the surround programs and surround decoders in
the “Sound Program” menu (p.85)
The sound mode can be applied separately to each input source.
When you play back audio signals with a sampling rate of higher than 96 kHz, the
straight decode mode (p.50) is automatically selected.
You can check which speakers are currently outputting sound by looking at the
speaker indicators on the unit’s front panel (p.10) or at the “Audio Signal” screen in
the “Information” menu (p.103).
Selecting the sound mode
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
INF
O
S
LEE
P
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
MOVIE
MUSIC
SUR.DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER
PURE DIRECT
ON SCREEN
ENTER
PROGRAM
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 48
Enjoying sound field effects (CINEMA DSP)
The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs that utilize Yamaha’s original DSP
technology (CINEMA DSP). It allows you to easily create sound fields like actual movie
theaters or concert halls in your room.
Sound programs suitable for movies (MOVIE)
The following sound programs are optimized for viewing video sources, such as
movies, TV programs, and games.
MOVIE THEATER
ENTERTAINMENT
Standard
This program creates a sound field that emphasizes the surround feeling
without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multichannel audio,
such as Dolby Digital and DTS. Its design is based on the concept of the
ideal movie theater, in which the audience is surrounded by beautiful
reverberations from the left, right, and rear.
Spectacle
This program delivers the scale and grandeur of spectacular movie
productions. It delivers an expansive sound space to match the
cinemascope wide-screen, and boasts a broad dynamic range, providing
everything from small delicate sounds to powerful loud booms.
Sci-Fi
This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the
latest Sci-Fi and SFX movies. You can enjoy a variety of
cinematographically created virtual spaces reproduced with clear
separation between dialogue, sound effects, and background music.
Adventure
This program is ideal for reproducing the sound design of action and
adventure movies precisely. The sound field restrains reverberations, but
puts emphasis on reproducing a sensation of expansiveness on both sides,
powerful space expanded widely to the left and right. The restrained depth
creates a clear and powerful space, while also maintaining the articulation
of the sounds and the separation of the channels.
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
Sci-Fi
VOL.
Sound program category
Sound program
“CINEMA DSP” lights up
Drama
This program features stable reverberations that match a wide range of
movie genres, from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The
reverberations are modest, but suitably stereophonic. The sound effects
and background music are reproduced with a gentle echo that does not
impinge on the articulation of the dialogue. You’ll never get tired listening for
long periods.
Mono Movie
This program reproduces monaural video sources, such as classic movies,
in an atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program creates a
pleasant space with depth, by adding breadth and the appropriate
reverberation to the original audio.
Sports
This program allows listeners to enjoy the rich vividness of sport broadcasts
and light entertainment programs. In sports broadcasts, the commentators’
voices are positioned clearly at the center, while the atmosphere inside the
stadium is realistically conveyed by the peripheral delivery of the sounds of
the fans in a suitable space.
Action Game
This program is suitable for action games, such as car racing and fighting
games. The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects makes the player
feel like they are right in the middle of the action, allowing for greater
concentration. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music
Enhancer for a more dynamic and strong sound field.
Roleplaying Game
This program is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This
program adds depth to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction
of background music, special effects, and dialogue from a wide variety of
scenes. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music
Enhancer for a clearer and more spatial sound field.
Music Video
This program allows you to enjoy videos of pop, rock, and jazz concerts, as
if you were there yourself. Immerse yourself in the hot concert atmosphere
thanks to the vividness of the singers and solos on stage, a presence
sound field that emphasizes the beat of rhythm instruments, and a surround
sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall.
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 49
Sound programs suitable for music/stereo playback
(MUSIC)
The following sound programs are optimized for listening to music sources.
You can also select stereo playback.
CLASSICAL
LIVE/CLUB
STEREO
Hall in Munich
This program simulates a Munich concert hall with approximately 2,500
seats that uses stylish wood for the interior finishing. Fine, beautiful
reverberations spread richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener’s
virtual seat is at the center left of the arena.
Hall in Vienna
This program simulates a 1,700-seat, middle-sized concert hall with a
shoebox shape that is traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings
create extremely complex reverberations from all around the audience,
producing a very full, rich sound.
Chamber
This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling, like an
audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable
for courtly music and chamber music.
Cellar Club
This program simulates an intimate concert venue with a low ceiling and
homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field delivers powerful sounds
that make you feel as if you are sitting in the front row in front of a small
stage.
The Roxy Theatre
This program creates the sound field of a 460-seat rock music concert
venue in Los Angeles. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the
hall.
The Bottom Line
This program creates the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a
famous New York jazz club once. The floor can seat 300 people to the left
and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant sound.
2ch Stereo
Use this program to mix down multichannel sources to 2 channels. When
multichannel signals are input, they are down mixed to 2 channels and
output from the front speakers (this program does not utilize CINEMA DSP).
7ch Stereo
Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you play back
multichannel sources, the unit mixes down the source to 2 channels, and
then outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger
sound field and is ideal for background music at parties.
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 50
Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields
(CINEMA DSP 3D)
CINEMA DSP 3D creates a natural stereoscopic sound field in your
room.
CINEMA DSP 3D functions when both of the following conditions
are met.
• One of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is
selected (p.48).
“CINEMA DSP 3D Mode” (p.79) in the “Option” menu is set to
“On”.
We recommend using presence speakers in order to experience the full effect of
the stereoscopic sound fields. However, even when no presence speakers are
connected, the unit creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front,
center, and surround speakers to produce stereoscopic sound fields.
Enjoying sound field effects without
surround speakers (Virtual CINEMA DSP)
If you select one of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and
7ch Stereo) when no surround speakers are connected, the unit
automatically creates the surround sound field using the front-side
speakers.
Enjoying unprocessed playback
You can play back input sources without any sound field effect
processing.
Playing back in original channels
(straight decode)
When the straight decode mode is enabled, the unit produces
stereo sound from the front speakers for 2-channel sources such as
CDs, and produces unprocessed multichannel sounds for
multichannel sources.
1Press STRAIGHT.
Each time you press the key, the straight decode mode is
enabled or disabled.
To enable 6.1/7.1-channel playback from 5.1-channel sources when surround
back speakers are used, set “Extended Surround” (p.80) in the “Option” menu to a
setting other than “Off”.
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
3
Hall in Vienna
VOL.
PL PR
“CINEMA DSP n” lights up
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
STRAIGHT
VOL.
SBL SBR
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
STRAIGHT
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 51
Playing back 2-channel sources in
multichannel (surround decoder)
The surround decoder enables unprocessed multichannel
playback from 2-channel sources. When a multichannel source is
input, it works the same way as the straight decode mode.
For details on each decoder see “Glossary” (p.120).
1Press SUR.DECODE to select a surround decoder.
Each time you press the key, the surround decoder
changes.
You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoders when headphones are
connected or when “Surround Back” in the “Setup” menu is set to “None”.
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct)
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the unit plays back the
selected source with the least circuitry in order to reduce the
electrical noise from other circuitry (such as the front display). It
allows you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound quality.
1Press PURE DIRECT.
Each time you press the key, the Pure Direct mode is
enabled or disabled.
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, the following functions are not available.
– Some settings for the speakers or sound programs
– Operating the on-screen menu
– Using the multi-zone function
– Audio output from the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks
– Viewing information on the front display (when not in operation)
bPro Logic Uses the Dolby Pro Logic decoder suitable for all
sources.
bPLIIx Movie Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro
Logic II decoder) suitable for movies.
bPLII Movie
bPLIIx Music Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro
Logic II decoder) suitable for music.
bPLII Music
bPLIIx Game Use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder (or Dolby Pro
Logic II decoder) suitable for games.
bPLII Game
Neo:6 Cinema Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder suitable for movies.
Neo:6 Music Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder suitable for music.
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
ProLogic
VOL.
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SLSR
SBL SBR
PUREDIRECT
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
PURE DIRECT
SUR.DECODE
PLAYBACK Selecting the sound mode En 52
Enjoying compressed music with enhanced
sound (Compressed Music Enhancer)
Compressed Music Enhancer adds depth and breadth to the
sound, allowing you to enjoy a dynamic sound close to the original
sound before it was compressed. This function can be used along
with any other sound modes.
1Press ENHANCER.
Each time you press the key, Compressed Music Enhancer
is enabled or disabled.
Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on signals whose sampling
rate is over 48 kHz.
You can also use “Enhancer” (p.80) in the “Option” menu to enable/disable
Compressed Music Enhancer.
Enjoying surround sound with headphones
(SILENT CINEMA)
You can enjoy surround or sound field effects, like a multichannel
speaker system, with stereo headphones by connecting the
headphones to the PHONES jack and selecting a sound program
or a surround decoder.
SW
C
L
SLSR
ENHANCER
R
Enhancer On
VOL.
SBL SBR
“ENHANCER” lights up
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENHANCER
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 53
You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or
selecting from registered radio stations.
The radio frequencies differ depending on the country or region where the unit is
being used. The explanation of this section uses a display with frequencies used
in a Europe model.
If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the FM/AM
antennas.
Selecting a frequency for reception
1Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input
source.
2Press BAND to select a band (FM or AM).
3Use the following keys to set a frequency.
TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency. Hold down the
key for about a second to search stations automatically.
Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to
select 98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT).
“TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio
station.
“STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received.
“Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of
reception range.
You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM
radio reception in “FM Mode” (p.80) in the “Option” menu. When the signal
reception for an FM radio station is unstable, switching to monaural may
improve it.
Listening to FM/AM radio
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
VOL.
SBL SBR
FM87.50MHz
VOL.
STEREO
TUNED
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
SBL SBR
FM98.50MHz
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
PRE
S
E
T
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
TUNING
BAND
TUNER
Numeric keys
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 54
Registering favorite radio stations (presets)
You can register up to 40 radio stations as presets. Once you have
registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their
preset numbers.
You can automatically register FM radio stations that have strong signals by using
“Auto Preset” (p.57).
Registering a radio station
Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number.
1Follow “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.53)
to tune into the desired radio station.
2Hold down MEMORY for more than 2 seconds.
The first time that you do register a station, the selected
radio station will be registered to the preset number “01”.
Thereafter, each radio station you select will be registered
to the next empty (unused) preset number after the most
recently registered number.
To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning
into the desired radio station, press PRESET to select a preset number, and
then press MEMORY again.
Selecting a preset station
Tune into a registered radio station by selecting its preset number.
1Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input
source.
2Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired radio
station.
You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by
using the numeric keys after pressing PRESET once.
“No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered.
“Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered.
“Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered.
To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.57).
STEREO
TUNED
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
VOL.
01:FM98.50MHz
SBL SBR
Preset number
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
STEREO
TUNED
VOL.
02:Empty
SBL SBR
“Empty” (not in use) or the frequency currently registered
STEREO
VOL.
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SLSR
SBL SBR
01:FM98.50MHz
PRESET
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
MEMORY
PRESET
TUNER
Numeric keys
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 55
Radio Data System tuning
(Europe model only)
Radio Data System is a data transmission system used by FM
stations in many countries. The unit can receive various types of
Radio Data System data, such as “Program Service”, “Program
Type,” “Radio Text” and “Clock Time”, when it is tuned into a Radio
Data System broadcasting station.
Displaying the Radio Data System
information
1Tune into the desired Radio Data System
broadcasting station.
We recommend using “Auto Preset” to tune into the Radio Data System
broadcasting stations (p.57).
2Press INFO.
Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes.
About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for
the displayed item appears.
“Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text”, and “Clock Time” are not
displayed if the radio station does not provide the Radio Data System
service.
Receiving traffic information
automatically
When “TUNER” is selected as the input source, the unit
automatically receives traffic information. To enable this function,
follow the procedure below to set the traffic information station.
1When “TUNER” is selected as the input source,
press OPTION.
2Use the cursor keys to select “Traffic Program”
(TrafficProgram) and press ENTER.
The traffic information station search will start in 5 seconds.
Press ENTER again to start the search immediately.
To search upward/downward from the current frequency, press the cursor
keys (q/w) while “READY” is displayed.
To cancel the search, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display.
The following screen appears for about 3 seconds when the
search finishes.
“TP Not Found” appears for about 3 seconds when no traffic information
stations are found.
Program Service Program service name
Program Type Current program type
Radio Text Information on the current program
Clock Time Current time
DSP Program Sound mode name
Audio Decoder Decoder name
Frequency Frequency
STEREO
VOL.
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SLSR
SBL SBR
ProgramType
INFO
Item name
STEREO
VOL.
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SLSR
SBL SBR
CLASSICS
9850
Information
STEREO
VOL.
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SLSR
SBL SBR
TPFM101.30MHz
FINISH
Traffic information station (frequency)
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
INFO
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 56
Operating the radio on the TV
You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the
TV.
1Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input
source.
The playback screen is displayed on the TV.
Playback screen
1Radio station information
Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected
band (FM/AM) and frequency.
(Europe model only)
When tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.55), the
Radio Data System information (“Program Service”, “Program Type,”
“Radio Text” and “Clock Time”) is also displayed.
2Band icon
(Except for Europe model)
Select this icon and press ENTER to switch between FM and AM.
3TUNED/STEREO indicators
“TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station.
“STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received.
4Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
2
13
4
Menu Submenu Function
Manual Tuning
FM (Europe model only)
Switches to FM/AM.
AM
Tuning (+/-) Selects a frequency.
Auto (+/-) Selects a radio station automatically.
Memory Registers the selected station as
presets.
Direct Enters a frequency directly.
Browse Moves to the browse screen (preset
station list).
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows
the background. Press one of the
menu operation keys to redisplay it.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
TUNER
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Listening to FM/AM radio En 57
Browse screen
1Preset station list
Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor keys to select a preset
station and press ENTER to tune into it.
2Preset number
3Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
Menu Submenu Function
Utility
Memory Registers the current station to the
preset number selected in the list.
Auto Preset
Automatically registers FM radio
stations with strong signals (up to 40
stations).
Clear Preset Clear the preset station selected in the
list.
Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations.
1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the
list.
1 Page Down
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows
the background. Press one of the
menu operation keys to redisplay it.
3
2
1
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back iPod music En 58
You can play back iPod music on the unit using a USB cable
supplied with the iPod.
Some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or software
version of the iPod.
To play back iPod videos on the unit, an Apple Composite AV Cable (not supplied)
is required. Connect the USB and composite video plugs of the Apple Composite
AV cable to the USB jack and VIDEO jack on the front panel. To select a video,
operate the iPod itself in the simple play mode (p.60).
Connecting an iPod
Connect your iPod to the unit with the USB cable supplied with the
iPod.
1Connect the USB cable to the iPod.
2Connect the USB cable to the USB jack.
The iPod charges while it is connected to the unit. If you set the unit to standby
mode while the iPod is charging, the iPod continues to charge up to 4 hours. If
“Network Standby” (p.98) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, it continues to change
until full.
Disconnect the iPod from the USB jack when it is not in use.
Playing back iPod music
Supported iPods (as of January 2012)
iPod touch, iPod nano (2nd gen. to 6th gen.)
iPhone 4S, iPhone 4, iPhone 3GS, iPhone 3G, iPhone
iPad2, iPad
RADIO
STRAIGHT
VIDEO
iPod/iPhone/iPad
5V 2.1A
HDMI IN
VIDEO
VOLUME
AUX USB
The unit (front)
VOL .
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
Connected
USB
PLAYBACK Playing back iPod music En 59
Playback of iPod content
Follow the procedure below to operate the iPod contents and start
playback.
You can control the iPod with the menu displayed on the TV screen.
1Press USB to select “USB” as the input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
If playback is ongoing on your iPod, the playback screen is displayed.
2Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback
screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
To operate the iPod manually to select content or control playback, switch to the
simple play mode (p.60).
Browse screen
1Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.61) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2List name
3Contents list
Displays the list of iPod content. Use the cursor keys to select an item and
press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4Item number/total
5Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
1
5
3
2
4
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
USB
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back iPod music En 60
Playback screen
1Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.61) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining
time.
Use the cursor keys to select scrollable information.
3Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys on the remote control to
control playback.
Operating the iPod itself or remote control
(simple play)
1Press MODE to switch to the simple play mode.
The TV menu screen turns off and iPod operations are
enabled.
To display the TV menu screen, press MODE again.
2Operate your iPod itself or the remote control to
start playback.
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control
aResumes playback from pause.
sStops playback.
dStops playback temporarily.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
hSearches forward/backward (by holding
down).
j
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu
operation keys to redisplay it.
1
3
2
Operational remote control
keys Function
Cursor keys Select an item.
ENTER Confirms the selection.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
External device
operation keys
aStarts playback or stops playback
temporarily.
d
sStops playback.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
hSearches forward/backward (by holding
down).
j
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
MODE
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Playing back iPod music En 61
Repeat/shuffle settings
You can configure the repeat/shuffle settings of your iPod.
During simple play, configure the repeat/shuffle settings directly on your iPod or
press MODE to display the TV menu screen and then follow the procedure below.
1When “USB” is selected as the input source, press
OPTION.
2Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
“Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
Songs (Songs) Plays back songs in random order. x
appears in the TV screen.
Albums
(Albums)
Plays back albums in random order. “x
appears in the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly.
c” appears in the TV screen.
All (All) Plays back all songs repeatedly. “v
appears in the TV screen.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
MODE
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 62
You can play back music files stored on a USB storage device on
the unit. Refer to the instruction manuals for the USB storage
device for more information.
The unit supports USB mass storage class devices (FAT16 or
FAT32 format).
The unit supports WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC and FLAC
files.
The unit is compatible with sampling rate of up to 96 kHz for WAV and FLAC files,
and 48 kHz for other files.
Some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or manufacturer
of the USB storage device.
Connecting a USB storage device
1Connect the USB storage device to the USB jack.
If the USB storage device contains many files, it may take time to load the them. In
this case, “Loading...” appears in the front display.
Disconnect the USB storage device from the USB jack when it is not in use.
Playback of USB storage device contents
Follow the procedure below to operate the USB storage device
contents and start playback.
You can control the USB memory device with the menu displayed
on the TV screen.
1Press USB to select “USB” as the input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
If playback is ongoing on your USB storage device, the playback screen is
displayed.
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device
RADIO
STRAIGHT
VIDEO
iPod/iPhone/iPad
5V 2.1A
HDMI IN
VIDEO
AUX USB
USB
The unit (front)
USB storage device
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SLSR
SBL SBR
Connected
USB
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
USB
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 63
2Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback
screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected.
Browse screen
1Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.64) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2List name
3Contents list
Displays the list of USB storage device contents. Use the cursor keys to
select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4Item number/total
5Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
1
5
3
2
4
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on a USB storage device En 64
Playback screen
1Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.64) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time.
Use the cursor keys to select scrollable information.
3Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on
the remote control to control playback.
Repeat/shuffle settings
You can configure the repeat/shuffle settings for playback of USB
storage device contents.
1When “USB” is selected as the input source, press
OPTION.
2Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
“Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control
aResumes playback from pause.
sStops playback.
dStops playback temporarily.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu
operation keys to redisplay it.
1
3
2
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
On (On)
Plays back songs in the current album
(folder) in random order. “x” appears on
the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly.
c” appears on the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs in the current album
(folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the
TV screen.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 65
You can play back music files stored on your PC or
DLNA-compatible NAS on the unit.
To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the same router
(p.32). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address)
are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.104) in the “Information” menu.
The unit supports playback of WAV (PCM format only), MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC
and FLAC files.
The unit is compatible with sampling rates of up to 96 kHz for WAV and FLAC files,
and 48 kHz for other files.
To play back FLAC files, you need to install server software that supports sharing
of FLAC files via DLNA on your PC or use a NAS that supports FLAC files.
Media sharing setup
To play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible
NAS, first you need to configure the media sharing setting on each
music server.
For a PC with Windows Media Player
installed
1Check that Windows Media Player 11 or later is
installed on your PC.
2In the media sharing settings, enable media sharing
and allow media to be shared with the device.
For a PC or a NAS with other DLNA server
software installed
Refer to the instruction manual for the device or software and
configure the media sharing settings.
Playback of PC music contents
Follow the procedure below to operate the PC music contents and
start playback.
You can control the PC/NAS with the menu displayed on the TV
screen.
1Press NET repeatedly to select “SERVER” as the
input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
If playback of a music file selected from the unit is ongoing on your PC, the
playback screen is displayed.
2Use the cursor keys to select a music server and
press ENTER.
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
NET
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 66
3Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback
screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected.
Browse screen
1Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.67) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2List name
3Contents list
Displays the list of PC content. Use the cursor keys to select an item and
press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4Item number/total
5Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
1
5
3
2
4
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) En 67
Playback screen
1Status indicators
Display the current repeat/shuffle settings (p.67) and playback status
(such as play/pause).
2Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time.
Use the cursor keys to select scrollable information.
3Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on
the remote control to control playback.
You can also use a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control
playback. For details, see “DMC Control” (p.83).
Repeat/shuffle settings
You can configure the repeat/shuffle settings for the playback of PC
music content.
1When “SERVER” is selected as the input source,
press OPTION.
2Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
“Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control
aResumes playback from pause.
sStops playback.
dStops playback temporarily.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation
keys to redisplay it.
1
3
2
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
On (On)
Plays back songs in the current album
(folder) in random order. “x” appears on
the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly.
c” appears on the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs in the current album
(folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the
TV screen.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Listening to Internet radio En 68
You can listen to Internet radio stations from all over the world.
You can control the Internet radio with the menu displayed on the
TV screen.
To use this function, the unit must be connected to the Internet (p.32). You can
check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly
assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.104) in the “Information” menu.
This service may be discontinued without notice.
You may not be able to receive some Internet radio stations.
The unit uses the vTuner Internet radio station database service.
1Press NET repeatedly to select “NET RADIO” as the
input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
2Use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER.
If an Internet radio station is selected, playback starts and
the playback screen is displayed.
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
Listening to Internet radio
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
NET
Cursor keys
PLAYBACK Listening to Internet radio En 69
Browse screen
1Playback indicator
2List name
3Contents list
Displays the list of Internet radio content. Use the cursor keys to select an
item and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
4Item number/total
5Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
You can register your favorite Internet radio stations to the “Bookmarks” folder by
accessing the following website with the web browser on your PC. To use this
feature, you need the unit’s vTuner ID and your e-mail address in order to create
your personal account. You can find the vTunerID (MAC address of the unit) in
“Network” (p.104) in the “Information” menu.
http://yradio.vtuner.com/
Playback screen
1Playback indicator
2Playback information
Displays the station name, album name, song title, and elapsed time.
3Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s) on the remote
control to control playback.
Some information may not be available depending on the station.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation keys
to redisplay it.
1
5
3
2
4
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control sStops playback.
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu
operation keys to redisplay it.
1
3
2
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) En 70
The AirPlay function allows you to play back iTunes/iPod music on
the unit via network.
To use this function, the unit and your PC or iPod must be connected to the same
router (p.32). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP
address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.104) in the “Information”
menu.
Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents
Follow the procedure below to play back iTunes/iPod music
contents on the unit.
1Turn on the unit, and start iTunes on the PC or
display the playback screen on the iPod.
If the iTunes/iPod recognizes the unit, the AirPlay icon
( ) appears.
If the icon does not appear, check whether the unit and PC/iPod are
connected to the router properly.
2On the iTunes/iPod, click (tap) the AirPlay icon and
select the unit (network name of the unit) as the
audio output device.
3Select a song and start playback.
The unit automatically selects “AirPlay” as the input source and
starts playback.
The playback screen is displayed on the TV.
Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay)
Supported iTunes/iPods (as of January 2012)
iTunes 10.2.2 or later (Windows/Mac)
iPod touch, iPhone or iPad with iOS 4.3.3 or later
PC
iTunes
Router
Playback starts
iPod
Starts playback
on iTunes
or iPod
The unit
iTunes (example) iPod (example)
iTunes (example) iPod (example)
Network name of the unit
PLAYBACK Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay) En 71
The playback screen is available only when your TV is connected to the unit via
HDMI.
You can turn on the unit automatically when starting playback on iTunes or iPod by
setting “Network Standby” (p.98) in the “Setup” menu to “On”.
You can edit the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on
iTunes/iPod in “Network Name” (p.99) in the “Setup” menu.
If you select the other input source on the unit during playback, playback on the
iTunes/iPod stops automatically.
To adjust the unit’s volume from the iTunes/iPod, set “Volume Interlock” (p.83) in
the “Input” menu to “Limited” (default) or “Full”.
Playback screen
1Playback indicator
2Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining
time.
3Operation menu
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the
selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
You can also use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on
the remote control to control playback.
To control iTunes playback with the remote control of the unit, you need to
configure the iTunes preferences to enable iTunes control from remote speakers
in advance.
Caution
When you use iTunes/iPod controls to adjust volume, the volume may be
unexpectedly loud. This could result in damage to the unit or speakers. If the
volume suddenly increases during playback, stop playback on the iTunes/iPod
immediately.
1
3
2
Menu Submenu Function
Play Control
aResumes playback from pause.
dStops playback temporarily.
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu operation
keys to redisplay it.
iTunes (example of English version)
Check this box
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
DI
S
PLA
Y
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
PLAYBACK Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 72
The multi-zone function allows you to play back different input
sources in the room where the unit is installed (main zone) and in
another room (Zone2).
For example, while you are watching TV in the living room (main
zone), another person can listen to radio in the study room (Zone2).
Analog audio sources (including FM/AM radio), and USB and network sources
can be output to Zone2. To listen to the playback of an external device in Zone2,
you need to connect the device to the AUDIO jacks (AV 5–6 or AUDIO 1–2 jacks)
of the unit.
(HTR-7065 only)
The party mode (p.76) allows you to play back the same audio output in main zone
as Zone2, whatever the input audio signal type.
Preparing Zone2
Connect the device that will be used in Zone2 to the unit. The
connection method varies depending on the amplifier being used
(the unit or an external amplifier).
Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone)
Living room (main zone)
Study room (Zone2)
Caution
Remove the unit’s power cable from the AC wall outlet before connecting
speakers or an external amplifier.
Ensure that the core wires of the speaker cable do not touch one another or
come into contact with the unit’s metal parts. Doing so may damage the unit
or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “Check SP Wires” will
appear on the front display when the unit is turned on.
PLAYBACK Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 73
Using the unit’s internal amplifier
Connect the speakers placed in Zone2 to the unit with speaker
cables.
To utilize the EXTRA SP terminals for Zone2 speakers, set “Power
Amp Assign” (p.91) in the “Setup” menu to “7ch +1ZONE” after
connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet.
When Zone2 output is enabled (p.75), the surround back speakers in the main
zone do not output sound.
Using an external amplifier
Connect the external amplifier (with volume control) placed in
Zone2 to the unit with a stereo pin cable.
FRONT CENTER SURROUND
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/BI AMP
ZONE 2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
PRE OUT
SINGLE CENTER
SUBWOOFER
12
SPEAKERS
FL FR
12
3
45
76
9
The unit (rear)
Main zone
Zone2
FRONT CEN
T
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE 2
OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
HDMI 4 HDMI 5HDMI 3HDMI 2
FM
12V
0.1A
ZONE2
OUT
L
R
AUDIO
L
R
12
3
45
76
9
QW
The unit (rear)
ZONE2 OUT jacks
Zone2
Main zone
External amplifier
Audio input
(analog stereo)
PLAYBACK Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 74
Operating the unit from Zone2
(remote connection)
You can operate the unit and external devices from Zone2 using the
supplied remote control if you connect an infrared signal
receiver/emitter to the unit’s REMOTE IN/OUT jacks.
To operate external devices with the supplied remote control, you must register a
remote control code for each device before using (p.108).
Remote connections between Yamaha products
An infrared signal transmitter is not required if you are using
Yamaha products that support remote connections, as the unit
does. You can transmit remote control signals by connecting the
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks with monaural mini-jack cables and an
infrared signal receiver.
3AV 4 AV 5
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2
AV
OUT
AV 6
O
OPTICAL
(TV)
X
IAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
OUT
IN
REMOTE
TRIGGER OUT
P
B
Y
P
R
HDMI 1
(BD/DVD)
HDMI 3HDMI 2
ANTENNA
(RADIO)
HDMI
12
OUT
ARC
FM
AM
12V
0.1A
IN
OUT
REMOTE
The unit (rear) REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
Infrared signal
transmitter
External device
(such as a CD player)
Remote control
Infrared signal
receiver
Zone2
Main zone
IN
OUT
REMOTE
IN
OUT
REMOTE
Remote control
Infrared signal
receiver
Yamaha products
(up to six, including the unit)
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
Zone2
PLAYBACK Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 75
Controlling Zone2
1Set MAIN/ZONE2 to “ZONE2”.
2Press RECEIVER z.
Each time you press the key, Zone2 output is enabled or
disabled.
When Zone2 output is enabled, “ZONE2” lights up in the
front display.
3Use the following keys to select an input source.
AV 5–6: AV 5–6 (AUDIO) jacks
AUDIO 1–2: AUDIO 1–2 jacks
TUNER: FM/AM radio
USB: USB jack (on the front panel)
NET: NETWORK jack (press repeatedly to select a desired
network source)
You cannot select USB and network sources exclusively for each zone. For
example, if you select “SERVER” for Zone2 when “USB” is selected for the
main zone, the input source for the main zone also switches to “SERVER”.
4Start playback on the external device or select a
radio station.
Refer to the instruction manual for the external device.
For details on the following operations, see the
corresponding pages.
Listening to FM/AM radio (p.53)
Playing back iPod music (p.58)
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device
(p.62)
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)
(p.65)
Listening to Internet radio (p.68)
Playing back iTunes/iPod music via a network (AirPlay)
(p.70)
The on-screen operations are not available for Zone2. Use the front display
to control Zone2.
To set the sleep timer (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off), press SLEEP
repeatedly. The Zone2 output will be disabled after a specified period of
time.
To adjust the Zone2 volume, press VOLUME or MUTE (when using the
unit’s internal amplifier). When using an external amplifier, use the volume
control on it.
Caution
To avoid unexpected noise, never play back DTS-CDs in Zone2.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
P
R
OG
RA
M
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
MUSI
C
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
SLEEP
VOLUME
MUTE
AV 5–6
AUDIO 1–2
TUNER
USB
NET
MAIN/ZONE2
RECEIVER z
PLAYBACK Playing back music in multiple rooms (multi-zone) En 76
Enjoying the same source in multiple
rooms (party mode)
(HTR-7065 only)
The party mode allows you to play back in Zone2 the same music
that is being played back in the main zone. During the party mode,
stereo playback is automatically selected for all zones. Utilize this
function when you want to use main zone music as background
music for a house party.
1Press PARTY.
Each time you press the key, the party mode is turned on or
off.
When the party mode is turned on, “PARTY” lights up in the
front display.
If the party mode does not work on Zone2, set “Party Mode Set” (p.100) in
the “Setup” menu to “Enable” (default).
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
PARTY
PLAYBACK Viewing the current status En 77
Switching information on the front display
1Press INFO.
Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes.
About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for
the displayed item appears.
Available items vary depending on the selected input source. The displayed
item can also be applied separately to each input source group.
Viewing the status information on the TV
1Press DISPLAY.
The following information is displayed on the TV.
* HTR-7065 only
2To close the information display, press DISPLAY.
Viewing the current status
Input source group Item
HDMI 1–5
V-AUX
AV 16
AUDIO 1–2
Input (input source name), DSP Program (sound
mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name)
TUNER
Frequency (frequency), DSP Program (sound mode
name), Audio Decoder (decoder name)
* (Europe model only)
Radio Data System data is also available when the unit is
tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.55).
USB
SERVER
AirPlay
Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album
name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio
Decoder (decoder name)
* During simple playback of iPod:
Input (input source name), DSP Program (sound mode
name), Audio Decoder (decoder name)
NET RADIO
Song (song title), Album (album name), Station
(station name), DSP Program (sound mode name),
Audio Decoder (decoder name)
VOL.
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
AudioDecoder
Item name
VOL.
SW
C
L
SLSR
R
ProLogic
Information
Input source/
Party mode
status*
Audio format/
Decoder
Compressed Music Enhancer status
CINEMA DSP status
Sound
mode
Volume
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
INFO
DISPLAY
PLAYBACK Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 78
You can configure separate playback settings for different playback sources. This
menu is available on the front panel (or on the TV screen), allowing you to easily
configure settings during playback.
1Press OPTION.
Front display
TV screen
2Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Option menu items
Available items vary depending on the selected input source.
Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display.
Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu)
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SLSR
SBL SBR
ToneControl
OPTION Item Function Page
Tone Control
(Tone Control)
Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency
range of sounds. 79
Adaptive DRC
(Adaptive DRC)
Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to
minimum) is automatically adjusted when the volume
is adjusted.
79
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode
(CINEMA DSP 3D) Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D. 79
Dialogue Adjust
(Dialog Adjust)
Dialogue Level
(Dialog Lvl) Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. 79
Dialogue Lift
(Dialog Lift) Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. 79
Extended Surround
(EXTD Surround)
Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources
when surround back speakers are used. 80
Volume Trim
(Volume Trim)
Input Trim
(In.Trim) Corrects volume differences between input sources. 80
Subwoofer
Trim (SW.Trim) Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume. 80
Enhancer
(Enhancer) Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer. 80
Video Mode
(Video Mode)
Enables/disables the video signal processing
settings configured in the “Setup” menu. 80
FM Mode
(FM Mode)
Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio
reception. 80
Traffic Program
(TrafficProgram)
(Europe model only)
Automatically searches for a traffic information
station.
55
Repeat
(Repeat)
Configures the repeat setting for the iPod (p.61),
USB storage device (p.64), or media server (p.67).
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Configures the shuffle setting for the iPod (p.61),
USB storage device (p.64), or media server (p.67).
PLAYBACK Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 79
Tone Control (Tone Control)
Adjusts the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) of sounds.
Choices
Treble (Treble), Bass (Bass)
Setting range
-6.0 dB to Bypass (Bypass) to +6.0 dB, *0.5 dB increments
Default
Bypass (Bypass)
If you set an extreme value, sounds may not match those from other channels.
Adjusting with the front panel controls
aPress TONE CONTROL to select “Treble” or “Bass”.
bPress PROGRAM to make an adjustment.
Adaptive DRC (Adaptive DRC)
Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is automatically adjusted
when the volume level is adjusted. When it is set to “On”, it is useful for listening to
playback at a low volume at night.
Settings
If “On” is selected, the dynamic range becomes narrow at a low volume and wide at a
high volume.
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (CINEMA DSP 3D)
Enables/disables CINEMA DSP 3D (p.50). If this function is set to “On”, CINEMA DSP
3D functions with the selected sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo).
Settings
Dialogue Adjust (Dialog Adjust)
Adjusts the volume or perceive height of dialogue sounds.
Dialogue Level (Dialog Lvl)
Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. If dialogue sounds cannot be heard clearly, you
can turn up its volume by increasing this setting.
Setting range
0 to 3
Default
0
Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift)
Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. If the dialogue sounds as if it is
coming from below the TV screen, you can raise its perceived height by increasing this
setting.
This setting is available only when one of the following conditions is met.
One of the sound programs (except for 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is selected when presence speakers
are used.
Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) (p.50) is working.
Setting range
0 to 5 (The bigger the value the higher the position)
Default
0
On (On) Automatically adjusts the dynamic range.
Off (Off) (default) The dynamic range is not automatically adjusted.
Volume: low Volume: high
Input level Input level
On
Off
On
Off
Output level
Output level
On (On) (default) Enables CINEMA DSP 3D.
Off (Off) Disables CINEMA DSP 3D.
Ideal position
PLAYBACK Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) En 80
Extended Surround (EXTD Surround)
Selects how to play back 5.1- to 7.1-channel sources when surround back speakers
are used.
Settings
Some Dolby Digital EX or DTS-ES sources do not contain a flag for reproducing surround back channel. In
this case, the unit reproduces the signals in 5.1-channel if “Extended Surround” is set to “Auto”. To
reproduce the signals in 6.1 or 7.1-channel, set it to “bPLIIx Movie”, “bPLIIx Music”, or “EX/ES”.
Volume Trim (Volume Trim)
Fine-adjusts volume difference between input sources or subwoofer volume.
Input Trim (In.Trim)
Corrects volume differences between input sources. If you are bothered by volume
differences when switching between input sources, use this function to correct it.
This setting is applied separately to each input source.
Setting range
-6.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments)
Default
0.0 dB
Subwoofer Trim (SW.Trim)
Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume.
Setting range
-6.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments)
Default
0.0 dB
Enhancer (Enhancer)
Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.52).
This setting is applied separately to each input source.
You can also use ENHANCER on the remote control to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer
(p.52).
Settings
Default
TUNER, USB, (network sources): On (On)
Others: Off (Off)
Video Mode (Video Mode)
Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio) settings
configured in “Processing” (p.95) in the “Setup” menu.
Settings
FM Mode (FM Mode)
Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception.
Settings
Auto (Auto)
(default)
Automatically selects the most suitable decoder if signals that contain
surround back channel signals are input, and reproduces the signals
in 6.1- or 7.1-channel. If two surround back speakers are connected,
the unit reproduces the 5.1-channel signals in 7.1-channel.
bPLIIx Movie
(bPLIIxMo)
Always reproduces signals in 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic
IIx Movie decoder. This setting is available only when two surround
back speakers are connected.
bPLIIx Music
(bPLIIxMu)
Always reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro
Logic IIx Music decoder. This setting is available only when one or two
surround back speakers are connected.
EX/ES (EX/ES) Automatically selects the Dolby EX or DTS-ES decoder, and
reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel.
Off (Off)
Always reproduces signals in their original channels. (Even when
DTS-ES or Dolby Digital EX signal is input, the unit reproduces the
signal in 5.1-channel.)
Off (Off) Disables Compressed Music Enhancer.
On (On) Enables Compressed Music Enhancer.
Processing
(Processing) Enables the video signal processing.
Direct (Direct)
(default) Disables the video signal processing.
Stereo (Stereo)
(default) Receives FM radio in stereo sounds.
Mono (Mono) Receives FM radio in monaural sounds.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring input sources (Input menu) En 81
CONFIGURATIONS
You can change the input source settings using the TV screen.
1Press ON SCREEN.
2Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an input source to be configured
and press the cursor key (q).
The input source of the unit also changes.
You can still switch the input source by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3.
4Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
5Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Input menu items
Available items vary depending on the selected input source.
Configuring input sources (Input menu)
Item Function Page
Rename/Icon Select Changes the input source name and icon. 82
Audio In Combines the video jack of the selected input source with an
audio jack of others. 82
Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS. 82
Volume Interlock Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via
AirPlay. 83
Video Out Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. 83
DMC Control Selects whether to allow a DLNA-compatible Digital Media
Controller (DMC) to control playback. 83
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring input sources (Input menu) En 82
Rename/Icon Select
Changes the input source name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Input sources
HDMI 1–5, V-AUX, AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2, USB
Setup procedure
1Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a template and press the cursor key (w).
You cannot change the template or icon for “USB” when an iPod is connected.
2Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w).
3Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
4
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
5Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
6To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Audio In
Combines the video jack of the selected input source with an audio jack of others. For
example, use this function in the following cases.
Connecting a playback device that supports HDMI video output, but not HDMI audio
output
Connecting a playback device that has component video jacks and analog stereo
jacks (such as game consoles)
Input sources
HDMI 1–5, AV 1–2
Setup procedure
(To input audio through a digital optical jack)
Select “AV1” or “AV4” and connect the device to the unit’s corresponding audio jacks
with a digital optical cable.
(To input audio through a digital coaxial jack)
Select “AV2” or “AV3” and connect the device to the unit’s corresponding audio jacks
with a digital coaxial cable.
(To input audio through analog audio jacks)
Select “AV5”, “AV6”, “AUDIO1”, or “AUDIO2”, and connect the device to the unit’s
corresponding audio jacks with a stereo pin cable.
Decoder Mode
Sets the format of digital audio playback to “DTS”.
For example, if the unit does not detect DTS audio and outputs noise, set “Decoder
Mode” to “DTS”.
Input sources
HDMI 1–5, V-AUX, AV 1–4
Settings
Auto (default) Automatically selects an audio format to match the input audio signal.
DTS Selects DTS only. (Other audio signals are not reproduced.)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) En 83
Volume Interlock
Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay.
Input sources
AirPlay
Settings
Video Out
Selects a video to be output with the audio input source.
Input sources
TUNER, (network sources)
Settings
DMC Control
Selects whether to allow DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control
playback.
Input source
SERVER
Settings
A Digital Media Controller (DMC) is a device that can control other network devices through the network.
When this function is enabled, you can control playback of the unit from DMCs (such as Windows Media
Player 12) on the same network.
You can change the settings of the SCENE function (p.46) using the TV screen.
1Press ON SCREEN.
2Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a scene to be configured and
press the cursor key (q).
You can still switch the scene by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3.
Off Disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod.
Limited (default) Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod within the limited range
(-80 dB to 0 dB and mute).
Full Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod in the full range (-80 dB to
+16.5 dB and mute).
Off (default) Does not output video.
HDMI 1–5, AV 1–6,
V-AUX Outputs video input through the corresponding video input jacks.
Disable Does not allow DMCs to control playback.
Enable (default) Allows DMCs to control playback.
Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) En 84
4Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
5Use the cursor keys and ENTER to change the setting.
6To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Scene menu items
Save
Registers the unit’s current settings (input source, sound program/surround decoder,
Compressed Music Enhancer on/off, and HDMI output jack [HTR-7065 only]) in the
selected scene.
If you have changed the input assignment for a scene, you also need to change the external device
assigned to the corresponding SCENE key (p.46).
Load
Loads the settings registered for the selected scene.
Select “DETAIL” to configure the SCENE link playback setting or view the scene
assignments.
Device Control
Recalls a selected scene and starts its playback on an external device connected to
the unit via HDMI or on a Yamaha product connected to the REMOTE OUT jack.
(SCENE link playback)
Settings
Default
SCENE1 (BD/DVD), SCENE2 (TV): HDMI Control
SCENE3 (NET), SCENE4 (RADIO): Off
To control playback of an HDMI Control-compatible device by SCENE link playback, you need to set “HDMI
Control” in the “Setup” menu to “On” and perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.124).
Detail
Displays the assignments of the selected scene.
Item Function Page
Save Registers the current settings in the selected scene. 84
Load
Loads the settings registered for the selected scene. You can
also configure the SCENE link playback setting or view the
scene assignments.
84
Rename/Icon Select Changes the scene name and icon. 85
Reset Restores the default settings for the selected scene. 85
Off Disables the SCENE link playback function.
HDMI Control
Enables SCENE link playback using HDMI Control signals. Select this
if an HDMI Control-compatible device (such as a BD/DVD player) is
connected to the unit via HDMI. It also turns on the TV if it supports
HDMI Control.
IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 1
Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this
if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack.
IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 2
Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this
if a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack
and “IR: Yamaha BD/DVD 1” does not work properly.
IR: Yamaha CD Enables SCENE link playback using remote control signals. Select this
if a Yamaha CD player is connected to the REMOTE OUT jack.
Input Input source to be used
HDMI Output (HTR-7065 only)
HDMI OUT jack to be used
Mode Sound program/surround decoder to be used
Enhancer Compressed Music Enhancer on/off
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 85
Rename/Icon Select
Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Setup procedure
1Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w).
2Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
3Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the
entry.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
4Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
5To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Reset
Restores the default settings (p.46) for the selected scene.
You can change the settings of the sound programs and surround decoders using the
TV screen.
1Press ON SCREEN.
2Use the cursor keys to select “Sound Program” and press ENTER.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a sound program to be
configured and press the cursor key (q).
You can still switch the sound program by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3.
Configuring sound programs/surround
decoders (Sound Program menu)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 86
4Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
To restore the default settings for the selected sound program, select “Reset”.
5Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Sound Program menu items
Available items vary depending on the selected sound program or surround decoder.
Settings for sound programs
Item Function Settings
Decode Type
Selects a surround decoder to be used
in combination with the selected sound
program.
bPLIIx Movie (bPLII
Movie), Neo:6 Cinema
DSP Level Adjusts the sound field effect level.
-6 dB to +3 dB (default: 0 dB)
Higher to enhance the sound
field effect, and lower to
reduce it.
Initial Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and presence sound field
generation.
1 ms to 99 ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect, and lower to reduce it.
Surround Initial Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and surround sound field
generation. 1ms to 49ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect, and lower to reduce it.
Surround Back Initial
Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and surround back sound field
generation.
Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the
presence sound field. 0.1 to 2.0
Higher to enhance the
broadening effect, and lower
to reduce it.
Surround Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the
surround sound field.
Surround Back Room
Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
surround back sound field.
Liveness Adjusts the loss of the presence sound
field. 0 to 10
Higher to enhance the
reflectivity, and lower to
reduce it.
Surround Liveness Adjusts the loss of the surround sound
field.
Surround Back
Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the surround back
sound field.
Reverb Time Adjust the decay time of the rear
reverberant sound.
1.0 s to 5.0 s
Higher to enrich the
reverberant sound and lower
to have clear sound.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (Sound Program menu) En 87
The following items are available when you select “2ch Stereo” or “7ch Stereo”.
Available items in “7ch Stereo” vary depending on the speaker system being used.
Settings for decoders
The following items are available when you set “Decode Type” of “Surround Decoder”
to “bPLIIx Music” or “Neo:6 Music”.
Reverb Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and reverberant sound
generation.
0 ms to 250 ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect, and lower to reduce it.
Reverb Level Adjusts the volume of the reverberant
sound.
0% to 100%
Higher to strengthen the
reverberant sound, and lower
to weaken it.
Sound program
Item Function Settings
2ch Stereo Direct
Selects whether to
automatically bypass the
DSP and tone control
circuits when an analog
audio source is played
back.
Auto (default), Off
Select “Auto” to bypass the
circuits (when both “Treble”
and “Bass” are set to
“Bypass”).
7ch Stereo
Level Adjusts the entire volume. -5 to +5 (default: 0)
Front / Rear Balance Adjusts the front and rear
volume balance.
-5 to +5 (default: 0)
Higher to enhance the front
side, and lower to enhance
the rear side.
Left / Right Balance Adjusts the right and left
volume balance.
-5 to +5 (default: 0)
Higher to enhance the right
side, and lower to enhance
the left side.
Height Balance
Adjust the height volume
balance using the
presence speakers.
0 to 10 (default: 5)
Higher to enhance the
upside, and lower to
enhance the downside. (The
presence speakers do not
produce sounds when
“Height Balance” is set to
“0”.)
Monaural Mix Enables/disables
monaural sound output. Off (default), On
Item Function Settings
Decode Type Item Function Settings
bPLIIx Music
Panorama
Adjusts the broadening
effect of the front sound
field.
Off (default), On
Select “On” to wrap front right/left
channel sounds around the field
and generate a spacious sound
field in combination with the
surround sound field.
Center Width
Adjusts the broadening
effect of the center
sound field.
0 to 7 (default: 3)
Higher to enhance the broadening
effect, and lower to reduce it
(closer to center).
Dimension
Adjusts the difference in
level between the front
and surround sound
fields.
-3 to +3 (default: 0)
Higher to strengthen the front
sound field and lower to strengthen
the surround sound field.
Neo:6 Music Center Image
Adjusts the center
orientation level
(broadening effect) of
the front sound field.
0.0 to 1.0 (default: 0.3)
Higher to strengthen the center
orientation level (less broadening
effect) and lower to weaken (more
broadening effect).
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 88
You can configure the unit’s various function with the menu displayed on the TV screen.
1Press ON SCREEN.
2Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a menu.
4Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
5Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Configuring various functions (Setup menu)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 89
Setup menu items
Menu Item Function Page
Speaker
Auto Setup Automatically optimizes the speaker settings (YPAO). 37
Manual Setup
Power Amp Assign Selects a speaker system. 91
Configuration
Front Selects the size of the front speakers. 91
Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. 91
Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their size. 91
Surround Back Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their size. 92
Front Presence Selects whether or not presence speakers are connected. 92
Subwoofer Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase. 92
Extra Bass Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components. 92
Bass Cross Over Sets the lower limit of the low-frequency component that can be output from speakers whose size is set to “Small”. 92
Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position. 93
Level Adjusts the volume of each speaker. 93
Parametric EQ Adjusts the tone with an equalizer. 93
Test Tone Enables/disables the test tone output. 93
Sound
Lipsync
Delay Enable Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source. 94
Auto/Manual Select Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output. 94
Adjustment Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually. 94
Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. 94
Max Volume Sets the maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness. 94
Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. 95
Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level when the volume is adjusted. 95
Video Video Mode Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). 95
HDMI
HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control. You can also configure the relevant settings (such as ARC and TV audio input). 96
Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. 97
Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in standby mode. 97
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 90
Network
IP Address Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). 98
Network Standby Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from other network devices. 98
MAC Address Filter Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices. 98
Network Name Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices. 99
Multi Zone
Main Zone Set Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 99
Zone2 Set
Max Volume Sets the Zone2 maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness in the second zone. 100
Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on. 100
Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 100
Party Mode Set (HTR-7065 only)
Enables/disables switching to the party mode. 100
Function
Display Set
Dimmer (Front Display) Adjusts the brightness of the front display. 100
Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated. 100
Wall Paper Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV. 101
Trigger Output
Trigger Mode Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. 101
Target Zone Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized. 101
Memory Guard Prevents accidental changes to the settings. 102
ECO
Auto Power Down Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. 102
ECO Mode Enables/disables the eco mode (power saving mode). 102
Language Select an on-screen menu language. 103
Menu Item Function Page
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 91
Speaker (Manual Setup)
Configures the speaker settings manually.
Power Amp Assign
Selects a speaker system.
In addition to the 5.1- or 7.1-channel speaker system, various speaker configurations
are possible using the presence speakers, Zone2 speakers, or bi-amp connection.
Settings
Configuration
Configures the output characteristics of the speakers.
When you configure the speaker size, select “Large” if the woofer diameter of your speaker is 16 cm
(6-1/4”) or larger or “Small” if it is smaller than 16 cm (6-1/4”).
Front
Selects the size of the front speakers.
Settings
“Front” is automatically set to “Large” when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”.
Center
Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size.
Settings
Surround
Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their sizes.
Settings
Basic (default) Select this option when you use a normal speaker system (not using
Zone2 speakers or a bi-amp connection).
7ch +1ZONE Select this option when you use Zone2 speakers (p.73) in addition to
the speaker system in the main zone.
5ch BI-AMP Select this option when you connect front speakers that support
bi-amp connections (p.21).
Large
Select this option for large speakers.
The front speakers will produce all of the front channel frequency
components.
Small (default)
Select this option for small speakers.
The subwoofer will produce front channel low-frequency components
(configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
Large
Select this option for large speakers.
The center speaker will produce all of the center channel frequency
components.
Small (default)
Select this option for small speakers.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce center channel
low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
None Select this option when no center speaker is connected.
The front speakers will produce center channel audio.
Large
Select this option for large speakers.
The surround speakers will produce all of the surround channel
frequency components.
Small (default)
Select this option for small speakers.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround channel
low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
None
Select this option when no surround speakers are connected.
The front speakers will produce surround channel audio. Virtual
CINEMA DSP works when you select a sound program.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 92
Surround Back
Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their sizes.
Settings
This setting is not available when “Power Amp Assign” is set to “5ch BI-AMP”, or when “Surround” is set to
“None”.
Front Presence
Selects whether or not presence speakers are connected.
Settings
Subwoofer
Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase.
Settings
When the bass sound is lacking or unclear, switch the subwoofer phase.
Extra Bass
Sets the speakers to produce the front channel low-frequency components.
Settings
This setting is not available when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”, or when “Front” is set to “Small”.
Bass Cross Over
Sets the lower limit of the low-frequency components that can be output from a speaker
whose size is set to “Small”. A frequency sound lower than the specified value will be
produced from the subwoofer or front speakers
Settings
40 Hz, 60 Hz, 80 Hz (default), 90 Hz, 100 Hz, 110 Hz, 120 Hz, 160 Hz, 200 Hz
If the volume and crossover frequency are adjustable on your subwoofer, set the volume to half and
crossover frequency to maximum.
Large x1
Select this option when one large speaker is connected.
The surround back speaker will produce all of the surround back
channel frequency components.
Large x2
Select this option when two large speakers are connected.
The surround back speakers will produce all of the surround back
channel frequency components.
Small x1
Select this option when one small speaker is connected.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel
low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
Small x2 (default)
Select this option when two small speakers are connected.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel
low-frequency components (configurable in “Bass Cross Over”).
None
Select this option when no surround back speakers are connected.
The surround speakers and subwoofer (or front speakers) will
produce surround back channel audio.
Use (default) Select this option when presence speakers are connected.
None Select this option when no presence speakers are connected.
Use
Normal
(default)
Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase not
reversed). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect)
channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels.
Reverse
Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase reversed).
The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio
and low-frequency components from other channels.
None
Select this option when no subwoofer is connected. The front
speakers will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and
low-frequency components from other channels.
Off (default) Depending on the size of the front speakers, either the subwoofer or
front speakers produce the front channel low-frequency components.
On Both the front speakers and subwoofer produce the front channel
low-frequency components.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 93
Distance
Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position so that sounds from the
speakers reach the listening position at the same time. First, select the unit of distance
from “Meter” or “Feet”.
Choices
Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R,
Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer
Setting range
0.30 m to 24.00 m (1.0 ft to 80.0 ft), *0.05 m (0.2 ft) increments
Default
3.00 m (10.0 ft)
Level
Adjusts the volume of each speaker.
Choices
Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R,
Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer
Setting range
-10.0 dB to +10.0 dB (0.5 dB increments)
Default
0.0 dB
Parametric EQ
Adjusts the tone with an equalizer.
Settings
“YPAO:Flat”, “YPAO:Front”, and “YPAO:Natural” are available only when the measurement results of “Auto
Setup” have already been saved (p.37). Press ENTER again to view the measurement results.
Manual equalizer adjustment
1Set “Parametric EQ” to “Manual” and press ENTER.
2Press ENTER again to enter the edit screen.
3Use the cursor keys to select a speaker and press ENTER.
To restore the default settings for all speakers, select “PEQ Data Clear” and then “OK”.
To copy the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” (p.37) to the “Manual” fields for
fine adjustment, select “PEQ Data Copy” and then an equalizer type.
4Press ENTER to select an item.
Band: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a center frequency from the preset 7 bands
and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain.
Frequency: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the center frequency of the selected
band and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain.
Q: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the Q factor (bandwidth) of the selected band and
the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain.
Setting range
Gain: -20.0 dB to +6.0 dB
Center frequency: 31.3 HZ to 16.0 kHz
Q factor: 0.500 to 10.08
5To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Test Tone
Enables/disables the test tone output. Test tone output helps you to adjust the speaker
balance or equalizer while confirming its effect.
Settings
Manual Select this option when you want to adjust the equalizer manually.
For details, see “Manual equalizer adjustment”.
YPAO:Flat Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics.
YPAO:Front Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics as
the front speakers.
YPAO:Natural Adjusts all speakers to achieve a natural sound.
Through Does not use the equalizer.
Off (default) Does not output test tones.
On Outputs test tones automatically when you adjust the speaker balance
or equalizer.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 94
Sound
Configures the audio output settings.
Lipsync
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output.
Delay Enable
Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source.
Choices
HDMI 1–5, AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2
Settings
Auto/Manual Select
Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output.
Setting range
“Auto/Manual Select” is automatically set to “Manual” depending on the TV connected to the unit.
Adjustment
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually when “Auto/Manual
Select” is set to “Manual”. You can fine-adjust the audio output timing when
“Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Auto”.
Setting range
0 ms to 500 ms (1 ms increments)
Default
0 ms
“Offset” shows the difference between automatic adjustment and fine adjustment.
Dynamic Range
Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and
DTS signals) playback.
Settings
Max Volume
Sets the maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness.
Setting range
-30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB
Default
+16.5 dB
Disable Disable the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source.
Enable (default) Enables the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source.
Auto (default)
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output automatically when
a TV that supports an automatic lipsync function is connected to the
unit via HDMI.
If necessary, you can fine-adjust the audio output timing in
“Adjustment”.
Manual
Select this option when you want to adjust the delay between video
and audio output manually.
Adjust the audio output timing in “Adjustment”.
Maximum (default) Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range.
Standard Optimizes the dynamic range for regular home use.
Minimum/Auto
Sets the dynamic range for clear sound even at night or at low
volumes.
When playing back Dolby TrueHD signals, the dynamic range is
automatically adjusted based on the input signal information.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 95
Initial Volume
Sets the initial volume when the receiver is turned on.
Settings
Adaptive DSP Level
Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level when the volume
is adjusted.
Settings
Video
Configures the video output settings.
Video Mode
Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio).
Settings
When “Video Mode” is set to “Direct”, the unit transmits video signals with the least circuitry in order to
reduce video output delay.
Resolution
Selects a resolution to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to
“Processing”.
Settings
If you need to select a resolution that is not supported by your TV, set “MON.CHK” (p.106) in the
“ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “SKIP” and try again. (Note that the output video may not be displayed on
your TV normally.)
Off (default) Sets the level to the volume level of the unit when it last entered
standby mode.
On
Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB
increments).
(This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max
Volume.)
Off Does not adjust the effect level automatically.
On (default) Adjusts the effect level automatically. Direct (default) Disables the video signal processing.
Processing Enables the video signal processing.
Select a resolution and an aspect ratio in “Resolution” and “Aspect”.
Through Does not convert the resolution.
Auto (default) Selects a resolution automatically in accordance with TV resolution.
480p/576p, 720p,
1080i, 1080p, 4K
Output video signals with a selected resolution.
(Only the resolutions supported by your TV are selectable.)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 96
Aspect
Selects an aspect ratio to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to
“Processing”.
Settings
This setting functions only when 480i/576i or 480p/576p signals are converted into 720p, 1080i, 1080p, or
2160p (4K) signals.
HDMI
Configures the HDMI settings.
HDMI Control
Enables/disables HDMI Control (p.124).
Settings
To use HDMI control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.124) after connecting HDMI
Control-compatible devices.
TV Audio Input
Selects an audio input jack of the unit to be used for TV audio input when “HDMI
Control” is set to “On”. The unit’s input source automatically switches to TV audio when
the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner.
Settings
AV 1–6, AUDIO 1–2
Default
AV 4
When using ARC to input TV audio to the unit, you cannot use the input jacks selected here for connecting
an external device because the input will be used for TV audio input.
Through (default) Does not convert the aspect ratio.
16:9 Normal Outputs 4:3 video signals to a 16:9 TV with black bands on either side
of the screen.
Off (default) Disables HDMI Control.
On
Enables HDMI Control.
Configure the settings in “TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and “Standby
Sync”.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 97
ARC
Enables/disables ARC (p.23) when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”.
Settings
You do not need to change this setting normally. In case noises are produced from the speakers connected
to the unit because TV audio signals input to the unit via ARC are not supported by the unit, set “ARC” to
“Off” and use the TV’s speakers.
Standby Sync
Select whether to use HDMI control to link the standby behavior of the TV and the unit
when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”.
Settings
Audio Output
Selects a device to output audio.
This setting (except for “HDMI OUT2” [HTR-7065 only]) is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to
“Off”.
Amp
Enables/disables the audio output from the speakers connected to the unit.
Settings
HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2 (HTR-7065 only)
HDMI OUT (HTR-6065 only)
Enables/disables the audio output from a TV connected to the HDMI OUT jack.
Settings
Standby Through
Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the
unit is in standby mode. If this function is set to “On”, you can use the input selection
keys (HDMI 1–5) to select an HDMI input even when the unit is in standby mode (the
standby indicator on the unit blinks).
Settings
This setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”.
Off Disables ARC.
On (default) Enables ARC.
Off Does not set the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off.
On Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off.
Auto (default) Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off only when the
unit is receiving TV audio or HDMI signals.
Off Disables the audio output from the speakers.
On (default) Enables the audio output from the speakers.
Off (default) Disables the audio output from the TV.
On Enables the audio output from the TV.
Off (default) Does not output videos/audio to the TV.
On Outputs videos/audio to the TV.
(The unit consumes approximately 3 W of power.)
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 98
Network
Configures the network settings.
IP Address
Configures the network parameters (such as IP address).
DHCP
Select whether to use a DHCP server.
Settings
Manual network settings
1Set “DHCP” to “Off”.
2Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a parameter type and press ENTER.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to
select a value.
4To confirm the setting, press ENTER.
5To configure another network parameter, repeat steps 2 to 4.
6To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
7To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Network Standby
Selects whether the unit can be turned on from other network devices (network
standby).
Settings
MAC Address Filter
Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices.
Filter
Enables/disables the MAC address filter.
Settings
MAC Address 1–10
Specifies the MAC addresses (up to 10) of the network devices that will be permitted
access to the unit when “Filter” is set to “On”.
Procedure
1Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “MAC Address 1–5” or “MAC Address 6–10”
and press ENTER.
2Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an MAC address number and press ENTER.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to
select a value.
4To confirm the setting, press ENTER.
5To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
6To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Off Does not use a DHCP server. Configure the network parameters
manually. For details, see “Manual network settings”.
On (default) Uses a DHCP server to automatically obtain the unit’s network
parameters (such as IP address).
IP Address Specifies an IP address.
Subnet Mask Specifies a subnet mask.
Default Gateway Specifies the IP address of the default gateway.
DNS Server (P) Specifies the IP address of the primary DNS server.
DNS Server (S) Specifies the IP address of the secondary DNS server.
Off (default) Disables the network standby function.
On Enables the network standby function.
(The unit consumes approximately 2 W of power.)
Off (default) Disables the MAC address filter.
On
Enables the MAC address filter. In “MAC Address 1–10”, specify the
MAC addresses of the network devices that will be permitted access
to the unit.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 99
Network Name
Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network
devices.
Procedure
1Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
2Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the
entry.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
3Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
4To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Multi Zone
Configures the multi zone settings.
Main Zone Set
Configures the main zone setting.
Zone Rename
Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Procedure
1Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
2Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the
entry.
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
3Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
4To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 100
Zone2 Set
Configures the Zone2 settings.
Max Volume
Sets the Zone2 maximum volume to prevent excessive loudness.
Setting range
-30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB
Default
+16.5 dB
This setting is available only when “Power Amp Assign” (p.91) is set to “7ch +1ZONE”.
Initial Volume
Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on.
Settings
This setting is available only when “Power Amp Assign” (p.91) is set to “7ch +1ZONE”.
Zone Rename
Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen.
You can change the zone name in the same manner as “Zone Rename” in “Main Zone
Set” (p.99).
Party Mode Set
(HTR-7065 only)
Enables/disables switching to the party mode (p.76).
Choice
Target: Zone 2
Settings
Function
Configures the functions that make the unit easier to use.
Display Set
Configures the settings related to the front display and TV screen display.
Dimmer (Front Display)
Adjusts the brightness of the front display.
Setting range
-4 to 0 (higher to brighten)
Default
0
The front display may become dark when “ECO Mode” (p.102) is set to “On”.
Short Message
Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated
(such as input selection and volume adjustment).
Settings
Off (default) Sets the level at the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby
mode.
On
Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB
increments).
(This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max Volume”.)
Disable Disables switching to the party mode.
Enable (default) Enables switching to the party mode. You can turn on/off the party
mode by pressing PARTY on the remote control.
On (default) Displays short messages on the TV screen.
Off Does not display short messages on the TV screen.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 101
Wall Paper
Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV.
Settings
Trigger Output
Sets the TRIGGER OUT jack to function in sync with the power status of each zone or
input switching.
Trigger Mode
Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function.
Settings
Source
Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input, switching
when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”.
Choices
HDMI 1–5, AV 1–6, V-AUX, AUDIO 1–2, TUNER, (network sources), USB
Settings
Manual
Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually when “Trigger
Mode” is set to “Manual”. This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of
the external device connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack.
Choices
Target Zone
Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized.
Settings
Picture 1 (default),
Picture 2, Picture 3
Displays the selected image on the TV screen when there is no video
signal.
Gray Displays a gray background on the TV screen when there is no video
signal.
Power (default) The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the power status of the
zone specified with “Target Zone.”
Source
The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the input switching in
the zone specified with “Target Zone.”
An electronic signal is transmitted according to the setting made in
“Source.”
Manual Select this to manually switch the output level for electronic signal
transmission with “Manual.”
Low Stops the electronic signal transmission when you switch to the input
source specified in this option.
High (default) Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the input source
specified in this option.
Low Stops the electronic signal transmission.
High (default) Transmits the electronic signal.
Main
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the power status of the main zone.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the input switching in the main zone.
Zone2
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the power status of Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the input switching in Zone2.
All (default)
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the power status of the main zone or Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission
is synchronized with the input switching in the main zone or Zone2.
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring various functions (Setup menu) En 102
Memory Guard
Prevents accidental changes to the settings.
Settings
When “Memory Guard” is set to “On”, the lock icon (o) is displayed on the menu screen.
ECO
Configures the power supply settings.
Auto Power Down
Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. If you do not operate the unit for
the specified time, the unit will automatically go into standby mode.
Settings
Default
Europe model: 8 hours
Other models: Off
Just before the unit enters standby mode, “AutoPowerDown” appears and then countdown starts in the
front display.
ECO Mode
Enables/disables the eco (power saving) mode.
When the eco mode is enabled, you can reduce the unit’s power consumption.
Settings
The new setting will take effect after the unit is restarted.
When “ECO Mode” is set to “On”, the front panel display may become dark.
If you want to play audio at high volume, set “ECO Mode” to “Off”.
Off (default) Does not protect the settings.
On Protects the settings until “Off” is selected.
Icon
Off Does not set the unit to standby mode automatically.
2 hours, 4 hours,
8 hours, 12 hours
Sets the unit to standby mode when you have not operated the unit for
the specified time. For example, when “2 hours” is selected, the unit
will switch to standby mode if you do not operate it for 2 hours.
Off (default) Disables the eco mode.
On Enables the eco mode.
CONFIGURATIONS Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) En 103
Language
Select an on-screen menu language.
Settings
The information on the front display is provided in English only.
You can view information about the unit using the TV screen.
1Press ON SCREEN.
2Use the cursor keys to select “Information” and press ENTER.
3Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an information type.
4To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
English (default) English
日本語 Japanese
French
German
Spanish
Russian
Chinese
Français
Deutsch
Español
Viewing information about the unit (Information
menu)
CONFIGURATIONS Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) En 104
Types of information
Audio Signal
Displays information about the current audio signal.
Even when the unit is set to output bitstream signals directly, the signal may be converted depending on the
specifications and settings of the playback device.
Video Signal
Displays information about the current video signal.
HDMI Monitor
Displays information about the TVs connected to the HDMI OUT jacks.
(HTR-7065 only)
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to switch between “OUT1” and “OUT2”.
Network
Displays the network information on the unit.
System
Displays the system information on the unit.
If the unit detects a newer firmware over the network, “!” (exclamation mark) appears at the upper right of
the “Information” and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in this screen. You
can update the unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in this screen and following the procedure in “Updating
the unit’s firmware” (p.111).
Zone
Displays information about Zone2.
Input
Format Audio format of the input signal
Channel
The number of source channels in the input signal
(front/surround/LFE)
For example, “5.1 (3/2/0.1)” means 5.1ch in total
(3 front channels, 2 surround channels, and LFE).
Sampling The number of samples per second of the input digital signal
Bitrate The amount of data per second of the input bitstream signal
Dialogue The dialogue normalization level of the input bitstream signal
Output The speaker terminals from which signals are output
HDMI Signal Presence or absence of HDMI signal input/output
HDMI Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog or HDMI) and output signal (HDMI)
Analog Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog) and signal output at the MONITOR OUT
jacks (analog)
Interface TV interface
Video Resolution Resolutions supported by the TV
IP Address IP address
Subnet Mask Subnet mask
Default Gateway The IP address of the default gateway
DNS Server (P) The IP address of the primary DNS server
DNS Server (S) The IP address of the secondary DNS server
MAC Address MAC address
Network Name Network name (the unit’s name on the network)
Status The connection status of the NETWORK jack
Remote ID The unit’s remote control ID setting (p.106)
TV Format The unit’s video signal type (p.106)
Speaker Impedance The speaker impedance setting of the unit (p.105)
System ID System ID number
Firmware Version The version of firmware installed on the unit
Input The input source selected for Zone2
Volume The volume setting for Zone2
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 105
Configure the system settings of the unit while viewing the front display.
1Set the unit to standby mode.
2
While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE
z
.
3Press PROGRAM to select an item.
4Press STRAIGHT to select a setting.
5Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and turn it on
again.
The new settings take effect.
ADVANCED SETUP menu items
Changing the speaker impedance setting (SP IMP.)
Change the unit’s speaker impedance settings depending on the impedance of the
speakers connected.
Settings
Configuring the system settings
(ADVANCED SETUP menu)
MAIN ZONE z
STRAIGHTPROGRAM
Item Function Page
SP IMP. Changes the speaker impedance setting. 105
REMOTE ID Selects the unit’s remote control ID. 106
TV FORMAT Switches the video signal type. 106
MON.CHK Removes the limitation on HDMI video output. 106
INIT Restores the default settings. 106
UPDATE Updates the firmware. 107
VERSION Checks the version of firmware currently installed on the unit. 107
6 Ω MIN Select this option when you connect 6-ohm speakers to the unit. You
can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
8 Ω MIN (default) Select this option when you connect 8-ohm or higher speakers to the
unit.
SPIMP.8MIN
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 106
Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID)
Change the unit’s remote control ID so that it matches the remote control’s ID (default:
ID1). When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers, you can set each remote control with a
unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver.
Settings
ID1 (default), ID2
Changing the remote control ID of the remote control
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Otherwise, the setting will be
automatically canceled.
1Press CODE SET on the remote control.
2Press RECEIVER.
3Use the numeric keys to enter “5019” (ID1) or “5020” (ID2).
Once the remote control ID is registered successfully, SOURCE blinks twice.
If it blinks six times, registration failed. Repeat from Step 1.
The registered remote control codes (p.108) are not cleared even if you change the remote control ID.
Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT)
Switch the video signal type of the unit so that it matches to the format of your TV.
Settings
NTSC, PAL
Default
U.S.A. model: NTSC
Other models: PAL
Removing the limitation on HDMI video output
(MON.CHK)
The unit automatically detects resolutions supported by a TV connected to the HDMI
OUT jack.
Disable the monitor check function if you want to specify a resolution in “Resolution”
(p.95) when the unit cannot detect the TV’s resolution or when you want to specify a
different resolution than the detected resolution.
Settings
Reset to “YES” if the unit becomes inoperable because video from the unit cannot be displayed on the TV
after “MON.CHK” has been set to “SKIP”.
Restoring the default settings (INIT)
Restores the default settings for the unit.
Choices
REMOTEIDID1
TVFORMATNTSC
YES (default) Enables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a
resolution supported by the TV only.)
SKIP Disables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a
specified resolution regardless of compatibility with the TV.)
VIDEO Restores the default settings for video configurations.
ALL Restores the default settings for the unit.
CANCEL Does not perform an initialization.
MON.CHKYES
INITCANCEL
CONFIGURATIONS Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) En 107
Updating the firmware (UPDATE)
New firmware that provides additional features or product improvements will be
released as needed. Updates can be downloaded from our website. If the unit is
connected to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network. For details,
refer to the information supplied with updates.
Firmware update procedure
Do not perform this procedure unless firmware update is necessary. Also, make sure
you read the information supplied with updates before updating the firmware.
1Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “USB” or “NETWORK” and press INFO to
start firmware update.
Choices
If the unit detects newer firmware over the network, the corresponding message will be displayed after
ON SCREEN is pressed. In this case, you can also update the unit’s firmware by following the procedure in
“Updating the unit’s firmware” (p.111).
Checking the firmware version (VERSION)
Check the version of firmware currently installed on the unit.
You can also check the firmware version in “System” (p.104) in the “Information” menu.
USB Update the firmware using a USB memory device.
NETWORK Update the firmware via the network.
UPDATEUSB
VERSIONxx.xx
CONFIGURATIONS Controlling external devices with the remote control En 108
You can use the unit’s remote control to operate external devices
(such as BD/DVD players) if you have registered the remote control
code of the external device.
You cannot control an external device that does not have a remote control sensor.
Ensure that the remote control ID of the external device is set to “ID1”. If any other
ID is selected, the remote control operations may not work properly.
If the unit’s remote control is without batteries for more than 2 minutes, the
registered codes may be cleared. If this happens, insert new batteries and register
the codes again.
Under the unit’s default settings, the amplifier code (Yamaha: 5098) is set for all
the input selection keys. With this setting, you can control HDMI
Control-compatible devices connected to the unit with the remote control. (This
function may not work depending on the specification of the external device.)
Registering the remote control code for a TV
You can use the unit’s remote control to operate a TV if you have
registered its remote control code.
You can also register your TV’s remote control code to the unit’s input selection
keys (p.109). This would allow you to use the cursor keys or numeric keys to
operate the TV (this function may not be available on some TV models).
1Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM
to find your TV’s remote control code.
If there are multiple remote control codes, register the first code in the list.
If that does not work, try the other codes.
2Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens,
repeat from Step 2.
3Press TV z.
4Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote
control code.
Once the remote control code is successfully registered, SOURCE
blinks twice.
If it blinks six times, registration has failed. Repeat from Step 2.
TV operations
Once you have registered the remote control code for your TV, you
can control it using the TV operation keys, regardless of the input
source selected on the unit.
Controlling external devices with the remote control
TV operation keys
INPUT Switches the video inputs of the TV.
MUTE Mutes the audio output of the TV.
TV VOL Adjust the volume of the TV.
TV CH Switch the channels of the TV
TV zTurns on/off the TV.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
CODE SET
TV z
SOURCE
Numeric keys
TV operation keys
CONFIGURATIONS Controlling external devices with the remote control En 109
Registering the remote control codes for
playback devices
You can use the unit’s remote control to operate playback devices if
you have registered their remote control codes. You can also use
the input selection keys to change the playback devices that are
controlled by the remote control, because their remote control
codes are assigned to the input selection keys.
If you assign the remote control code for an external device to the star () key, you
can operate the device with the remote control without switching the input source
after pressing the star key.
1Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM
to find the remote control code for your playback
device.
If there are multiple remote control codes, register the first code in the list. If
that does not work, try the other codes.
2Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens,
repeat from Step 2.
3Press the input selection key.
For example, press HDMI 1 to set the remote control code
for the playback device connected to the HDMI 1 jack.
4Use the numeric keys to enter the 4-digit remote
control code.
Once the remote control code is registered successfully, SOURCE
blinks twice.
If it blinks six times, registration has failed. Repeat from Step 2.
For details on how to register a remote control code to a SCENE key, refer to
“Configuring scene assignments” (p.46).
Playback device operations
Once you have registered the remote control code for your
playback device, you can control it using the following keys after
selecting the input source or scene.
By pressing SOURCE or RECEIVER, you can switch the devices (the unit or
external device) that are operated by the menu operation keys, DISPLAY and
numeric keys. You can operate the unit after pressing RECEIVER (lights up in
orange), and an external device after pressing SOURCE (lights up in green). For
example, if you register the remote control code of your external device on
TUNER, you can operate the unit’s built-in FM/AM radio after pressing RECEIVER
and the external device after pressing SOURCE.
These keys work only if the corresponding function is available on your playback
device and if the device can be operated with an infrared remote control.
SOURCE zTurns on/off the playback device.
Menu operation
keys
Cursor keys Select an item.
ENTER Confirms a selected item.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen.
DISPLAY Switches information on the display.
External device
operation keys
TOP MENU Displays the top menu.
POP-UP/MENU Displays the pop-up menu.
sStops playback.
dStops playback temporarily.
aStarts playback of the selected
song/video.
hSearches forward/backward (by
holding down).
j
f
Skips forward/backward.
g
Numeric keys Enter numerical values.
TV operation keys Control the TV (p.108).
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
CODE SET
DISPLAY
SOURCE z
SOURCE
RECEIVER
Numeric keys
TV operation keys
Menu operation keys
External device
operation keys
Input selection keys
External device
operation keys
CONFIGURATIONS Controlling external devices with the remote control En 110
Resetting remote control codes
You can reset a remote control code registered to each input
selection key.
1Press CODE SET.
SOURCE blinks twice.
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Otherwise, the setting will be canceled. If this happens,
repeat from Step 1.
2Press the input selection key.
3Use the numeric keys to enter “5098”.
Once the remote control code is reset successfully, SOURCE blinks
twice.
If it blinks six times, resetting has failed. Repeat from Step 1.
To reset the remote control to factory default settings
aPress CODE SET.
bPress RECEIVER.
cUse the numeric keys to enter “9981”.
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
ENTE
R
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
CODE SET
RECEIVER
SOURCE
Numeric keys
Input selection keys
CONFIGURATIONS Updating the unit’s firmware En 111
New firmware that provides additional features or product
improvements will be released as needed. If the unit is connected
to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network and
update it.
You can also update the firmware using the USB memory device from the
“ADVANCED SETUP” menu (p.107).
A firmware update is available if the following message is displayed
after ON SCREEN is pressed.
1Read the on-screen description.
2To start the firmware update, use the cursor keys to
select “START” and press ENTER.
The on-screen display turns off.
3If “Update Success Please Power Off!” appears on
the front display, press MAIN ZONE z on the front
panel.
The firmware update is complete.
If you want to update the firmware later, select “CLOSE” in Step 2. “!” (exclamation
mark) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and a
message will be displayed in the “System” screen (p.104). You can update the
unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in the “System” screen.
Updating the unit’s firmware
Note
Do not operate the unit or disconnect the power cable or network cable during
firmware update. Firmware update takes about 20 minutes or more
(depending on your Internet connection speed).
Information
icon
Message
System Icon
TV VOL TV CH
TV
INPUT
MUTE
CODE SET
90
10
ENT
MEMORY
5687
1234
MOVIE
ENHANCER
TUNING PRESET
BAND
DISPLAYRETURN
ENTER
ON
SCREEN OPTION
TOP MENU
MUTE
PROGRAM VOLUME
POP-UP/MENU
PURE DIRECT
STRAIGHT
INFO SLEEP
MUSIC
NET
PARTY HDMI OUT
TUNER
MAIN
ZONE 2
USB
MODE
SCENE
BD
DVD TV
NET
RADIO
SOURCE
RECEIVER
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
5
65
V-AUX
1234
12
12
34
SUR. DECODE
TV
VO
L
TV
C
H
TV
INP
U
T
MUTE
CO
DE
SE
T
9
0
10
ENT
M
EM
O
RY
5
6
8
1 2
3
4
MO
VI
E
E
NHANCER
T
U
NIN
G
PRE
S
E
T
BAN
D
DI
S
PLA
Y
RETURN
O
N
S
CRE
E
N
O
PTI
O
N
T
OP MENU
M
UTE
P
R
OG
RA
M
V
O
L
U
M
E
P
O
P-UP
/
ME
N
U
PURE DIRECT
S
TRAI
G
H
T
INF
O
S
LEE
P
MUSI
C
NE
T
PARTY
H
DMI OU
T
TUN
E
R
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
U
SB
M
O
DE
SC
EN
E
BD
DV
D
TV
NET
RADI
O
SO
UR
C
E
R
E
C
EIVE
R
HDMI
AV
A
U
DI
O
5
6
5
V
-A
U
X
1
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
ENTER
Cursor keys
APPENDIX Frequently asked questions En 112
APPENDIX
The new speaker system does not provide an ideal sound
balance...
If you have changed speakers or have a new speaker system, use “Auto Setup” to
optimize the speaker settings again (p.37). If you want to adjust the speaker settings
manually, use “Manual Setup” in the “Setup” menu (p.91).
Since we have small children, we want to set limitations on the
volume control...
If a small child accidentally operates the controls on the main unit or remote control, the
volume may suddenly increase. This may also cause injury or damage the unit or
speakers. We recommend using “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the maximum
volume level for the unit in advance (p.94). You can also set the maximum volume for
Zone2 (p.100).
I am occasionally startled by a sudden loud sound when turning
on the unit...
By default, the volume level when the unit last entered standby mode is automatically
applied. If you want to fix the volume, use “Initial Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the
volume to be applied when the receiver is turned on (p.95). You can also set the initial
volume for Zone2 (p.100).
I made HDMI connections but HDMI Control does not work at
all...
To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.124). After
connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices (such as BD/DVD players) to the unit,
enable HDMI Control on each device and perform the HDMI Control link setup. This
setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your
system. For information on how HDMI Control works between your TV and playback
devices, refer to the instruction manuals for each device.
I want to turn off the on-screen messages displayed during
operations...
By default, short messages are displayed on the TV screen when the unit is operated
(such as input selection and volume adjustment). If the short messages bother you
when you are watching movies or sports, configure “Short Message” (p.100) in the
“Setup” menu to turn off the short messages.
I want to prevent accidental changes to the settings...
You can protect the settings configured on the unit (such as speaker settings) by
utilizing “Memory Guard” in the “Setup” menu (p.102).
The unit’s remote control is simultaneously controlling another
Yamaha product as well as the unit...
When using multiple Yamaha products, the remote control may work on another
Yamaha product or another remote control may work on the unit. If this happens,
register different remote control IDs for the devices that you want to control with each
remote control (p.106).
Frequently asked questions
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 113
Refer to the table below when the unit does not function properly.
If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below or if the instructions below do not help, turn off the unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized
Yamaha dealer or service center.
First, check the following:
aThe power cables of the unit, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are connected to AC wall outlets
securely.
bThe unit, subwoofer, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are turned on.
cThe connectors of each cable are securely inserted in to jacks on each device.
Power and system
Troubleshooting
Problem Cause Remedy
The power does not turn on.
The protection circuitry has been activated three times
consecutively. When the unit is in this condition, the standby
indicator on the unit blinks if you try to turn on the power.
As a safety precaution, capability to turn on the power is disabled. Contact your
nearest Yamaha dealer or service center to request repair.
The power does not turn off.
The internal microcomputer has frozen, due to an external electric
shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop
in the power supply voltage.
Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to
initialize and reboot the unit.
The power turns off (standby mode) immediately. The unit was turned on while a speaker cable was shorted. Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and
speakers (p.20).
The unit enters
standby mode automatically.
The sleep timer worked. Turn on the unit and start playback again.
The auto-standby function kicked in because the unit was not used
for the specified time.
To disable the auto-standby function, set “Auto Power Down” in the “Setup” menu
to “Off” (p.102).
The speaker impedance setting is incorrect. Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers (p.105).
The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short
circuit.
Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and
speakers (p.20).
The unit is not reacting.
The internal microcomputer is frozen, due to an external electric
shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop
in the power supply voltage.
Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to
initialize and reboot the unit.
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 114
Audio
Problem Cause Remedy
No sound.
Another input source is selected. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys.
Signals that the unit cannot reproduce are being input. Some digital audio formats cannot be played back on the unit. To check the audio
format of the input signal, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.104).
The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
The volume cannot be increased.
The maximum volume is set. Use “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the maximum volume (p.94).
A device connected to the output jacks of the unit is not turned on.
(This may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.) Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of the unit.
No sound is coming from a specific speaker.
The playback source does not contain a signal for the channel. To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.104).
The currently selected sound program/decoder does not use the
speaker. To check it, use “Test Tone” in the “Setup” menu (p.93).
Audio output of the speaker is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.37) or use “Configuration” in the “Setup” menu to change
the speaker settings (p.91).
The volume of the speaker is set too low. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.37) or use “Level” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the
speaker volume (p.93).
The speaker cable connecting the unit and the speaker is
defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another speaker cable.
The speaker is malfunctioning. To check it, replace with another speaker. If the problem persists, the unit may be
malfunctioning.
No sound is coming from the surround back
speaker. The extended surround is disabled. Use “Extended Surround” in the “Option” menu to select a decoder to be used
(p.80).
No sound is coming from the subwoofer.
The playback source does not contain LFE or low-frequency
signals.
To check it, set “Extra Bass” in the “Setup” menu to “On”, in order to output the
front channel low-frequency components from the subwoofer (p.92).
Subwoofer output is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.37) or set “Subwoofer” in the “Setup” menu to “Use”
(p.92).
The volume of the subwoofer is too low. Adjust the volume on the subwoofer.
The subwoofer has been turned off by its auto-standby function. Disable the auto-standby function of the subwoofer or adjust its sensitivity level.
No sound from the playback device (connected to
the unit with HDMI).
The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content
Protection). Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications.
The unit is set not to output audio input through HDMI jacks from
the SPEAKERS terminals. In “Audio Output” in the “Setup” menu, set “Amp” to “On” (p.97).
The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack exceeds
the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices.
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 115
Video
No sound from the TV (when HDMI Control is
used).
The TV is set to output audio from the TV speakers. Change the audio output setting on your TV so that the TV audio is output from the
speakers connected to the unit.
(If the TV is connected to the unit with an audio cable)
The TV audio input setting does not match the actual connection.
Use “TV Audio Input” in the “Setup” menu to select the correct audio input jack
(p.96).
(If you are trying to use ARC)
ARC is disabled on the unit or TV. Set “ARC” in the “Setup” menu to “On” (p.97). Also, enable ARC on the TV.
Only the front speakers work on multichannel
audio.
The playback device is set to output 2-channel audio (such as
PCM) only.
To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.104). If necessary,
change the digital audio output setting on the playback device.
Noise/hum is heard. The unit is too close to another digital or radio frequency device. Move the unit further away from the device.
The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
The sound is distorted.
The volume of the unit is too high. Turn down the volume. If “ECO Mode” is set to “On”, set it to “Off” (p.102).
A device connected to the units output jacks is not turned on. (This
may happen due to the nature of AV receivers.) Turn on all devices connected to the unit’s output jacks.
Problem Cause Remedy
Problem Cause Remedy
No video.
Another input source is selected on the unit. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys.
Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit.
The video signal output from the unit is not supported by the TV. Set “MON.CHK” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “YES” (p.106).
The cable connecting the unit and TV (or playback device) is
defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
No video from the playback device (connected to
the unit with HDMI).
The input video signal (resolution) is not supported by the unit.
To check the information about the current video signal (resolution), use “Video
Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.104). For information about video signals
supported by the unit, see “HDMI signal compatibility” (p.125).
The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content
Protection). Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications.
The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over
the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices.
The menu of the unit is not displayed on the TV. The TV is not connected to the unit via HDMI. You can display the menu of the unit on the TV only when they are connected with
an HDMI cable. If necessary, use an HDMI cable to connect them (p.23 to 26).
Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 116
FM/AM radio
USB and network
Problem Cause Remedy
FM radio reception is weak or noisy.
There is multi-path interference. Adjust the FM antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location.
Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter.
Set “FM Mode” in the “Option” menu to “Mono” to select monaural FM radio
reception (p.80).
Use an outdoor FM antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element
antenna.
AM radio reception is weak or noisy. The noises may be caused by fluorescent lamps, motors,
thermostats, or other electrical equipment.
It is difficult to completely eliminate noise. It may be reduced by using an outdoor
AM antenna.
Radio stations cannot be selected automatically.
Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter.
Select the station manually (p.53).
Use an outdoor antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element
antenna.
The AM radio signal is weak.
Adjust the AM antenna orientation.
Select the station manually (p.53).
Use an outdoor AM antenna. Connect it to the ANTENNA (AM) jack together with
the supplied AM antenna.
AM radio stations cannot be registered as
presets. Auto Preset has been used. Auto Preset is for registering FM radio stations only. Register AM radio stations
manually (p.54).
Problem Cause Remedy
The unit does not detect the USB device. The USB device is not connected to the USB jack securely. Turn off the unit, reconnect your USB device, and turn the unit on again.
The file system of the USB device is not FAT16 or FAT32. Use a USB device with FAT16 or FAT32 format.
Folders and files in the USB device cannot be
viewed. The data in the USB device is protected by the encryption. Use a USB device without an encryption function.
The network feature does not function. The network parameters (IP address) have not been obtained
properly.
Enable the DHCP server function on your router and set “DHCP” in the “Setup”
menu to “On” on the unit (p.98). If you want to configure the network parameters
manually, check that you are using an IP address which is not used by other
network devices in your network (p.98).
The unit does not detect the PC.
The media sharing setting is not correct. Configure the sharing setting and select the unit as a device to which music
contents are shared (p.65).
Some security software installed on your PC is blocking the access
of the unit to your PC. Check the settings of security software installed on your PC.
The unit and PC are not in the same network. Check the network connections and your router settings, and then connect the
unit and the PC to the same network.
APPENDIX Troubleshooting En 117
Remote control
The files in the PC cannot be viewed or played
back. The files are not supported by the unit or the media server.
Use the file format supported by both the unit and the media server. For
information about the file formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music
stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.65).
The Internet radio cannot be played.
The selected Internet radio station is currently not available. There may be a network problem at the radio station, or the service may have
been stopped. Try the station later or select another station.
The selected Internet radio station is currently broadcasting
silence.
Some Internet radio stations broadcast silence at certain of times of the day. Try
the station later or select another station.
Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of your
network devices (such as the router).
Check the firewall settings of your network devices. The Internet radio can be
played only when it passes through the port designated by each radio station.
The port number varies depending on the radio station.
Problem Cause Remedy
Problem Cause Remedy
The unit cannot be controlled using the remote
control.
The unit is out of the operating range. Use the remote control within the operating range (p.5).
The batteries are weak. Replace with new batteries.
The unit’s remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight or
strong lighting. Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition the unit.
The remote control is set to control external devices. Press RECEIVER to set the remote control to control the unit (the key lights up in
orange).
The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not
identical. Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.106).
External devices cannot be controlled using the
remote control.
The remote control is set to control the unit. Press SOURCE to set the remote control to control external devices (the key lights
up in green).
The corresponding remote control code is not set properly. Set the remote control code again (p.108). Even if the remote control code is
registered properly, some products may not respond to the remote control.
APPENDIX Error indications on the front display En 118
Error indications on the front display
Message Cause Remedy
Access denied Access to the PC is denied. Configure the sharing settings and select the unit as a device to which music contents are shared
(p.65).
Access error
The unit cannot access the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
The unit cannot access the iPod. Turn off the iPod and turn it on again.
There is a problem with the signal path from the network to the unit. Make sure your router and modem are turned on.
Check the connection between the unit and your router (or hub) (p.32).
Check SP Wires The speaker cables short circuit. Twist the bare wires of the cables firmly and connect to the unit and speakers properly.
Connect error The unit has detected the iPod, but cannot access it. Turn off the iPod and then turn it on again.
Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
No content There are no playable files in the selected folder. Select a folder that contains files supported by the unit.
No device The unit cannot detect the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
The unit cannot detect the iPod. Turn off the iPod and then turn it on again.
Please wait The unit is preparing for connecting to the network. Wait until the message disappears. If the message stays more than 3 minutes, turn off the unit and turn
it on again.
RemID Mismatch The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not
identical. Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.106).
Unable to play
The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the iPod for some
reason.
Check the song data. If it cannot be played on the iPod itself, the song data or storage area may be
defective.
The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the PC for some
reason.
Check if the format of files you are trying to play is supported by the unit. For information about the
formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.65). If
the unit supports the file format, but still cannot play back any files, the network may be overloaded with
heavy traffic.
Unknown iPod The connected iPod is not supported by the unit. Use an iPod supported by the unit (p.58).
USB Overloaded An overcurrent is flowing through the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
APPENDIX Ideal speaker layout En 119
Use this diagram as a guide. You do not need to adjust the speaker layout to the following diagram exactly.
Ideal speaker layout
12
3
45
6 7
99
QW
30 cm (1 ft) or more
0.5 to 1 m
(1.6 to 3.3 ft)
1.8 m
(5.9 ft)
0.5 to 1 m
(1.6 to 3.3 ft)
1.8 m
(5.9 ft)
Turn it slightly inward to
reduce wall reflections.
Turn it slightly inward to
reduce wall reflections.
1 Front speaker (L)
2 Front speaker (R)
3 Center speaker
4 Surround speaker (L)
5 Surround speaker (R)
6 Surround back speaker (L)
7 Surround back speaker (R)
Q Presence speaker (L)
W Presence speaker (R)
9 Subwoofer
10° to 30°10° to 30°
APPENDIX Glossary En 120
Audio information
Audio decoding format
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports
5.1-channel audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs.
Dolby Digital EX
Dolby Digital EX creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with Dolby
Digital Surround EX. This decoder adds a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports
7.1-channel audio. Dolby Digital Plus remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems
that support Dolby Digital. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
Dolby Pro Logic II
Dolby Pro Logic II enables 5-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are three modes available:
“Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources, and “Game mode” for game sources.
Dolby Pro Logic IIx
Dolby Pro Logic IIx enables 7-channel playback from 2-channel or multichannel sources. There are three
modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources and “Game mode” for
game sources (for 2-channel sources only).
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. to offer a
high-definition home theater experience with the quality of the studio master. Dolby TrueHD can carry up to
eight channels of 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This
technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. This
format remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital
Surround. This technology is used for music DVDs, etc.
DTS Digital Surround
DTS Digital Surround is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports
5.1-channel audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs.
DTS-ES
DTS-ES creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with DTS-ES. This
decoder adds a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound. In the DTS-ES Matrix 6.1 format, a
surround back sound is recorded in the surround channels, and in the DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 format, a
discrete surround back channel is recorded.
DTS Express
DTS Express is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel audio and allows a higher
compression rate than the DTS Digital Surround format developed by DTS, Inc. This technology is
developed for audio streaming services on the Internet and secondary audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports
7.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio remains fully compatible with the
existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This technology is used for audio on
BD (Blu-ray discs).
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio format developed to offer a high-definition home
theater experience with the quality of the studio master by DTS, Inc. DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to
eight channels of 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This
technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
DTS Neo:6
DTS Neo:6 enables 6-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are two modes available: “Music
mode” for music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources. This technology provides discrete
full-bandwidth matrix channels of surround sound.
DSD (Direct Stream Digital)
DSD (Direct Stream Digital) technology stores audio signals on digital storage media, such as SACD (Super
Audio CDs). The signals are stored at a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz. The highest
frequency response is equal to or higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This technology
offers better audio quality than that used for CDs.
FLAC
FLAC is a file format for lossless audio data compression. FLAC is inferior to lossy compressed audio
formats in compression rate but provides higher audio quality.
MP3
One of the compressed digital audio format used by MPEG. With psychoacoustic technologies, this
compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing data
quantity by about 1/10 maintaining a certain level of audio quality.
MPEG-4 AAC
An MPEG-4 audio standard. It is used for mobile telephones, portable audio players, and audio streaming
services on Internet because it allows a high compression rate of data while maintaining better audio quality
than MP3.
PCM (Pulse Code Modulation)
PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded, and transmitted. This
technology is the basis of all other audio format. This technology is used as a lossless audio format called
Linear PCM for audio on a variety of media, including CDs and BD (Blu-ray discs).
Glossary
APPENDIX Glossary En 121
Sampling frequency/Quantization bit
Sampling frequency and quantization bits indicate the quantity of information when an analog audio signal
is digitized. These values are noted as in the following example: “48 kHz/24-bit”.
Sampling frequency
Sampling frequency (the number of times the signal is sampled per second) is called the sampling rate.
When the sampling frequency is higher, the range of frequencies that can be played back are wider.
Quantization bit
The number of quantization bits indicate the degree of accuracy when converting the sound level into a
numeric value. When the number of quantized bits is higher, the expression of the sound level is more
accurate.
WAV
Windows standard audio file format, which defines the method of recording the digital data obtained by
converting audio signals. By default, the PCM method (no compression) is used, but you can also use other
compression methods.
WMA (Windows Media Audio)
One of the compressed digital audio formats developed by Microsoft Corporation. With psychoacoustic
technologies, this compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of
compressing data quantity by about 1/20 maintaining a certain level of audio quality.
Others
Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp)
A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. When you use the bi-amplification
connection, the unit drives the tweeter and woofer in a speaker with the discrete amplifiers. As a
consequence, the tweeter and woofer provide clear audio signal without the interference.
LFE (Low Frequency Effects) 0.1 channel
This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals and has a frequency range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This
channel is added to the channels for all bands with Dolby Digital or DTS to enhance low frequency audio
effects. This channel is labeled 0.1 because it is limited to only low frequency audio.
Lip sync
Video output sometimes lags behind audio output due to the complexity of signal processing caused by an
increase in video signal capacity. Lip sync is a technique for automatically correcting the timing lag
between audio and video output.
HDMI and video information
Component video signal
With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for luminance and
the Pb and Pr signals for chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because
each of these signals is independent.
Composite video signal
With the composite video signal system, color, brightness, and synchronization data signals are combined
and transmitted with a single cable.
Deep Color
Deep Color is a technology that HDMI specification supports. Deep Color increases the number of available
colors within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space. Conventional color systems
process the color using 8 bits. Deep Color processes the color with 10, 12, or 16 bits. This technology
allows HDTVs and other displays to increase from millions of colors to billions of colors and eliminate
on-screen color banding for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors.
HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the world-wide standard interface for digital audio/video
signal transmission. This interface transmits both digital audio and digital video signals using a single cable
without any loss. HDMI complies with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) and provides a
secure audio/video interface. For further information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at
“http://www.hdmi.org/”.
x.v.Color
“x.v.Color” is a technology that the HDMI specification supports. It is a more extensive color space than
sRGB and allows the expression of colors that were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with
the color gamut of sRGB standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and thus can produce more vivid,
natural images.
APPENDIX Glossary En 122
Yamaha technologies
CINEMA DSP (Digital Sound Field Processor)
Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is
best experienced in a theater that has many speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions
(such as room size, wall material, and number of speakers) can differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are
differences in the sound that you hear. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, CINEMA DSP,
Yamaha’s original DSP technology provides the audiovisual experience of a movie theater in your own
home.
CINEMA DSP 3D
The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA
DSP 3D mode achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the
accurate and intensive 3D sound fields in a listening room.
Compressed Music Enhancer
The Compressed Music Enhancer feature compensates for missing harmonics in compression music
formats (such as MP3). As a result, this technology provides improved performance for the overall sound
system.
SILENT CINEMA
Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for
headphones have been set for each sound program, so that accurate representations of all the sound
programs can be enjoyed on headphones.
Virtual CINEMA DSP
Virtual CINEMA DSP allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround speakers with
front left and right speakers. Even if the surround speakers are not connected, the unit creates the realistic
sound field in a listening room.
APPENDIX Glossary En 123
Video signal flow
Video signals input from a video device to the unit are
output to a TV as shown below.
Video conversion table
You can select the resolution and the aspect ratio applied to HDMI-output video processing in “Video Mode” (p.95) in the “Setup” menu.
The unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably.
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO VIDEO VIDEOVIDEO
m: Available
HDMI out COMPONENT VIDEO out VIDEO
out
Resolution 480i/
576i
480p/
576p 720p 1080i 1080p 4K 480i/
576i
480p/
576p 720p 1080i 480i/
576i
HDMI in
480i/576i mmmmmm
480p/576p mmmmm
720p mmmm
1080i mmmm
1080p/50, 60 Hz mmmm
1080p/24 Hz mm
4K m
COMPONENT
VIDEO in
480i/576i mmmmmmm
480p/576p m
720p m
1080i m
VIDEO in 480i/576i mmmmmm m
Video device The unit TV
HDMI outHDMI in
COMPONENT
VIDEO in
COMPONENT
VIDEO out
VIDEO
out
VIDEO
in
APPENDIX Information on HDMI En 124
HDMI Control
HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that
supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit (such as
power and volume) with TV remote control operations. You can also control playback
devices (such as HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players) connected to the unit with
an HDMI cable.
For details on connections, see “Connecting a TV” (p.23) and “Connecting video
devices (such as BD/DVD players)” (p.28).
Operations available from the TV’s remote control
Standby synchronization
Volume control including mute
Switching to input audio from the TV when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner
Switching to input video/audio from the selected playback device
Switching between audio output devices (the unit or TV speaker)
(Example)
Operations available from the unit’s remote control
Starting playback on the playback device and turning on the TV with a scene
selection (p.46)
Switching the TV input to display the on-screen menu (when ON SCREEN is pressed)
Controlling the playback device (playback and menu operations) without registering
remote control codes (p.109)
(Example)
To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the following HDMI Control link setup after
connecting the TV and playback devices.
This setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system.
1Turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices.
2Enable HDMI Control on the unit, TV, and playback devices (such as
HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players).
To enable HDMI Control on the unit, setHDMI Control” (p.96) in the “Setup”
menu to “On” and configure the related items (“TV Audio Input”, “ARC”, and
“Standby Sync”).
3Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off the unit and
playback devices.
4Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV.
5Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit.
6Check the followings.
On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected.
If not, select the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
Information on HDMI
HDMI Control
Turn off the TV
The unit turns off
(standby)
HDMI Control
Playback device
also turns off
HDMI Control
Press SCENE (BD/DVD)
Turns on and displays
video from the playback
device
HDMI Control
Playback starts
APPENDIX Information on HDMI En 125
7Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning
off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try unplugging the TV in Step 2 and plugging in the TV again in
Step 3. It may solve the problem. Also, HDMI Control may not work if the number of connected devices
exceeds the limit. In this case, disable HDMI Control on the devices not in use.
If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on
the TV.
We recommend using TV and playback devices from the same manufacturer so that HDMI Control works
more effectively.
HDMI signal compatibility
Audio signals
Video signals
The unit is compatible with the video signals of the following resolutions:
When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video/audio signals may not be output, depending
on the type of the DVD player.
The unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI devices. For details, refer to the instruction
manual for each device.
To decode audio bitstream signals on the unit, set the input source device appropriately so that the device
outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream signals on the playback device).
For details, refer to the instruction manual for the playback device.
Audio signal type Audio signal format Compatible media (example)
2ch Linear PCM 2ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio
Multichannel Linear PCM 8ch, 32 to 192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit DVD-Audio, BD (Blu-ray disc),
HD DVD
DSD 2/5.1ch, 2.8224 MHz, 1 bit SACD
Bitstream Dolby Digital, DTS DVD-Video
Bitstream
(High definition audio)
Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus,
DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD
High Resolution Audio, DTS
Express
BD (Blu-ray disc), HD DVD
VGA 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
480i/60 Hz 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
576i/50 Hz 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz
480p/60 Hz 3840 x 2160p/30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz (4K signals)
576p/50 Hz 4096 x 2160p/24 Hz (4K signals)
APPENDIX Trademarks En 126
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Pro Logic and the double-D symbol are
trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent Nos: 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,212,872;
7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 & other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS-HD, the
Symbol, & DTS-HD and the Symbol together are registered trademarks & DTS-HD Master Audio is a
trademark of DTS, Inc.
Product includes software. © DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
“Made for iPod,” “Made for iPhone,” and “Made for iPad” mean that an electronic accessory has been
designed to connect specifically to iPod, iPhone, or iPad, respectively, and has been certified by the
developer to meet Apple performance standards.
Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with safety and regulatory
standards.
Please note that the use of this accessory with iPod, iPhone, or iPad may affect wireless performance.
AirPlay, the AirPlay logo, iPad, iPhone, iPod, iPod nano, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other countries.
MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson.
This receiver supports network connections.
“HDMI,” the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks, or registered
trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
x.v.Color™
“x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation.
“SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation.
DLNA™ and DLNA CERTIFIED™ are trademarks or registered trademarks of Digital Living Network
Alliance. All rights reserved. Unauthorized use is strictly prohibited.
Windows®
Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries.
Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows 7, Windows Media Audio, Windows Media Connect and Windows
Media Player are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States
and/or other countries.
Trademarks
APPENDIX Specifications En 127
Input jacks
• Analog Audio
Audio x 4 (AV 5–6, AUDIO 1–2)
• Digital Audio (Supported frequencies: 32 kHz to 96 kHz)
Optical x 2 (AV 1, AV 4)
Coaxial x 2 (AV 2–3)
•Video
Composite x 5 (AV 3–6, VIDEO [Front Panel])
Component x 2 (AV 1–2)
• HDMI Input
HDMI x 6 (HDMI 1–5, V-AUX)
•Other
USB x 1 [Front Panel] (USB2.0)
USB x 1 [Rear Panel]
(For Yamaha Accessory, Power Supply Only)
NETWORK x 1 (100Base-TX)
Output jacks
• Analog Audio
[HTR-7065]
- Speaker Out x 9 (7 ch)
(FRONT L/R, CENTER,
SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R
*1
, EXTRA SP L/R
*2
)
*1 Note: Assignment is possible [SURROUND BACK,
BI-AMP (FRONT L/R)]
*2 Note: Assignment is possible [ZONE2, PRESENCE]
- Pre Out x 7 (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R)
- Subwoofer Out x 2 (SUBWOOFER 1–2, mono)
- AV OUT x 1
- AUDIO OUT x 1
- ZONE2 OUT x 1
- Headphone x 1
[HTR-6065]
- Speaker Out x 9 (7 ch)
(FRONT L/R, CENTER,
SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R
*1
, EXTRA SP L/R
*2
)
*1 Note: Assignment is possible [SURROUND BACK,
BI-AMP (FRONT L/R)]
*2 Note: Assignment is possible [ZONE2, PRESENCE]
- Subwoofer Out x 2 (SUBWOOFER 1–2, mono)
- AV OUT x 1
- AUDIO OUT x 1
- ZONE2 OUT x 1
- Headphone x 1
•Video
MONITOR OUT
- Component x 1
- Composite x 1
AV OUT
- Composite x 1
• HDMI Output
[HTR-7065]
HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT 1–2)
[HTR-6065]
HDMI OUT x 1
Remote jacks
REMOTE IN x 1
REMOTE OUT x 1
TRIGGER OUT x 1
HDMI
HDMI Specification: Deep Color, “x.v.Color,” Auto Lip Sync,
ARC (Audio Return Channel), 3D, 4K
• Video Format (Repeater Mode)
-VGA
- 480i/60 Hz
- 576i/50 Hz
- 480p/60 Hz
- 576p/50 Hz
- 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz
- 3840 x 2160p/30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz
- 4096 x 2160p/24 Hz
Audio Format
-Dolby TrueHD
- Dolby Digital Plus
- Dolby Digital
- DTS-HD Master Audio
- DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
- DTS Express
-DTS
-DSD 6-ch
- PCM 2-ch to 8-ch (Max. 192 kHz/24-bit)
Content Protection: HDCP compatible
Link Function: CEC supported
Specifications
APPENDIX Specifications En 128
TUNER
• Analog Tuner
[Europe model]
FM/AM with Radio Data System x 1 (TUNER)
[Other models]
FM/AM x 1 (TUNER)
USB
• Capable of iPod, Mass Storage Class USB Memory
• Current Supply Capacity: 2.1 A
Network
• PC Client Function
• Compatible with DLNA ver. 1.5
• AirPlay supported
• Internet Radio
Compatible Decoding Formats
• Decoding Format
- Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus
- Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX
- DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio,
DTS Express
- DTS, DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1
- DTS Digital Surround
• Post Decoding Format
- Dolby Pro Logic
- Dolby Pro Logic II Music, Dolby Pro Logic II Movie,
Dolby Pro Logic II Game
- Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie,
Dolby Pro Logic IIx Game
- DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema
Audio Section
• Rated Output Power (2-channel driven)
[HTR-7065]
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.09% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R................................................................. 95 W+95 W
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R............................................................. 110 W+110 W
Center..............................................................................110 W
Surround L/R ...................................................... 110 W+110 W
Surround Back L/R ............................................. 110 W+110 W
[HTR-6065]
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.09% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R................................................................. 90 W+90 W
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R............................................................. 105 W+105 W
Center..............................................................................105 W
Surround L/R ...................................................... 105 W+105 W
Surround Back L/R ............................................. 105 W+105 W
• Rated Output Power (1-channel driven)
[HTR-7065]
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R.....................................................................130 W/ch
Center ........................................................................130 W/ch
Surround L/R ..............................................................130 W/ch
Surround Back L/R .....................................................130 W/ch
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4 Ω)
[HTR-6065]
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R.....................................................................125 W/ch
Center ........................................................................125 W/ch
Surround L/R ..............................................................125 W/ch
Surround Back L/R .....................................................125 W/ch
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4 Ω)
Front L/R [Europe model] ...........................................150 W/ch
• Dynamic Power (IHF)
[HTR-7065]
Front L/R (8/6/4/2 Ω)...................................140/180/210/250 W
[HTR-6065]
Front L/R (8/6/4/2 Ω)...................................130/170/200/240 W
Damping Factor
Front L/R, 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 Ω.............................100 or more
• Input Sensitivity / Input Impedance
AV 5 etc. (1 kHz, 100 W/8 Ω) ............................. 200 mV/47 kΩ
Maximum Input Signal
AV 5 etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD, Effect On)............................2.3 V
Output Level / Output Impedance
REC OUT........................................................... 200 mV/1.2 kΩ
SUBWOOFER........................................................... 1 V/1.2 kΩ
ZONE2 OUT...................................................... 200 mV/1.2 kΩ
Headphone Jack Rated Output / Impedance
AV 5 etc. (1 kHz, 50 mV, 8 Ω)............................. 100 mV/560 Ω
• Frequency Response
AV 5 etc. to Front (10 Hz to 100 kHz)..........................+0/-3 dB
• Total Harmonic Distortion
AV 5 etc. to Front (Pure Direct)
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 50 W, 8 Ω) .............................. 0.06% or less
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)
AV 5 etc. (Input Shorted 250 mV, Speaker Out)
......................................................................... 100 dB or more
Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)
Front L/R (Speaker Out)..................................... 150 µV or less
Channel Separation
AV 5 etc. (Input 5.1 kΩ Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz)
.................................................................60 dB/45 dB or more
Volume Control
Range..............................................MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5 dB
Step.................................................................................0.5 dB
Tone Control Characteristics
Bass Boost/Cut .............................±6 dB/0.5 dB Step at 50 Hz
Bass Turnover ................................................................350 Hz
Treble Boost/Cut.......................... ±6 dB/0.5 dB Step at 20 kHz
Treble Turnover ............................................................. 3.5 kHz
• Filter Characteristics
(fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz)
H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back).......12 dB/oct.
L.P.F. (Subwoofer) .....................................................24 dB/oct.
APPENDIX Specifications En 129
Video Section
• Video Signal Type
[U.S.A. model] ................................................................. NTSC
[Other models].................................................................... PAL
• Video Signal Type (Video Conversion) .....................NTSC/PAL
• Video Signal Level
Composite ............................................................. 1 Vp-p/75 Ω
Component
Y.......................................................................... 1 Vp-p/75 Ω
Pb/Pr ................................................................ 0.7 Vp-p/75 Ω
• Video Maximum Input Level (Video Conversion Off)
....................................................................... 1.5 Vp-p or more
Video Signal to Noise Ratio ................................50 dB or more
• Monitor Out Frequency Response (Video Conversion Off)
Component ............................................ 5 Hz to 60 MHz, -3 dB
FM Section
• Tuning Range
[U.S.A. model] ............................................. 87.5 to 107.9 MHz
[Other models].................................87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz
• 50 dB Quiet Sensitivity (IHF, 1 kHz, 100% MOD.)
Mono................................................................. 3 µV (20.8 dBf)
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)
Mono................................................................................ 71 dB
Stereo ..............................................................................69 dB
• Harmonic Distortion (IHF, 1 kHz)
Mono................................................................................. 0.3%
Stereo ............................................................................... 0.5%
Antenna Input ................................................75 Ω unbalanced
AM section
• Tuning Range
[U.S.A. model] ................................................ 530 to 1710 kHz
[Other models]......................................... 531 kHz to 1611 kHz
General
• Power Supply
[U.S.A. model].................................................AC 120 V, 60 Hz
[Australia model] .............................................AC 240 V, 50 Hz
[Europe model] ...............................................AC 230 V, 50 Hz
• Power Consumption
[U.S.A. model].................................................... 400 W/500 VA
[Other models] ................................................................330 W
• Standby Power Consumption
HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off ........... 0.1 W (Typical)
HDMI Control On, Standby Through On (No Signals)
..........................................................................3.0 W (Typical)
Network Standby On .........................................2.0 W (Typical)
• Dimensions (W x H x D)
[HTR-7065]... 435 x 171 x 368 mm (17-1/8” x 6-3/4” x 14-1/2”)
[HTR-6065]... 435 x 171 x 364 mm (17-1/8” x 6-3/4” x 14-3/8”)
•Weight
[HTR-7065] ....................................................10.8 kg (23.8 lbs)
[HTR-6065] ....................................................10.2 kg (22.5 lbs)
* Specifications are subject to change without notice.
APPENDIX Index En 130
Symbols
key .........................................................13
Lock icon (o) .........................................102
Numerics
2.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................17
2ch Stereo (Sound program) ....................49
3.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................17
4.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................17
4K signal (Video signal resolution) .........125
5.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................17
5ch BI-AMP
(Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) ........91
6.1-channel system
(Speaker connection) ............................20
6.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................16
7.1+2-channel system
(Speaker connection) ............................19
7.1+2-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................16
7.1-channel system
(Speaker connection) ............................19
7.1-channel system
(Speaker placement) ............................16
7ch +1ZONE
(Power Amp Assign, Setup menu) ........91
7ch Stereo (Sound program) ....................49
A
Access control (Network device) ..............98
Action Game (Sound program) ................ 48
Adaptive DRC (Option menu) .................. 79
Adaptive DSP Level
(Sound, Setup menu) ........................... 95
Adjustment (Lipsync, Setup menu) .......... 94
ADVANCED SETUP menu ...................... 105
ADVANCED SETUP menu item list ........ 105
Adventure (Sound program) .................... 48
AirPlay ...................................................... 70
AM antenna .............................................. 32
Amp (Audio Output, Setup menu) ............ 97
ARC (Audio Return Channel) ................... 23
ARC (HDMI Control, Setup menu) ........... 97
ARC-compatible TV (Connection) ............ 23
Aspect (Video Mode, Setup menu) .......... 96
Audio Decoder (Front display) ................. 77
Audio device connection ......................... 31
Audio In (Input menu) .............................. 82
AUDIO jack .............................................. 22
AUDIO OUT jack ...................................... 33
Audio Output (HDMI, Setup menu) .......... 97
Audio Return Channel .............................. 23
Audio Signal (Information menu) ............ 104
Auto Power Down
(ECO, Setup menu) ............................ 102
Auto Preset (FM radio) ............................. 57
Auto/Manual Select
(Lipsync, Setup menu) ......................... 94
Automatic preset (FM radio) .................... 57
AV OUT jack ............................................. 33
B
Banana plug ............................................. 20
Bass (Option menu) ................................. 79
Bass Cross Over
(Speaker, Setup menu) ........................ 92
Battery ........................................................ 5
Bi-amp speaker connection ..................... 21
Bitrate
(Audio Signal, Information menu) ....... 104
Bitstream ................................................ 125
C
Cellar Club (Sound program) ................... 49
Center (Speaker, Setup menu) ................ 91
Center Image (Sound Program menu) ..... 87
Center Width (Sound Program menu) ...... 87
Chamber (Sound program) ...................... 49
CINEMA DSP ............................................ 48
CINEMA DSP 3D ...................................... 50
CINEMA DSP 3D (Option menu) .............. 79
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (Option menu) .... 79
CLASSICAL
(Sound program category) ................... 49
Clock Time (Radio Data System) ............. 55
COAXIAL jack .......................................... 22
Combination of video/audio input jacks ... 29
Component video cable ........................... 22
Component video connection
(Playback device) ................................ 28
COMPONENT VIDEO jack ....................... 22
Composite AV Cable ................................ 58
Composite video connection
(Playback device) ................................ 29
Compressed Music Enhancer .................. 52
Configuration (Scene function) ................ 46
Connection (Audio devices) ..................... 31
Connection (iPod) .................................... 58
Index
APPENDIX Index En 131
Connection (NAS) .....................................32
Connection (Speaker cable) .....................20
Connection (Speaker) ...............................19
Connection (Subwoofer) ...........................21
Connection (Video devices) ......................28
Crossover frequency setting
(Subwoofer) ...........................................37
D
DC OUT jack .............................................11
Decode Type (Sound Program menu) ......86
Decoder Mode (Input menu) ....................82
Default Gateway ........................................98
Delay Enable (Lipsync, Setup menu) .......94
Detail (Load, Scene menu) .......................84
Device Control (Load, Scene menu) .........84
DHCP (IP Address, Setup menu) ..............98
Dialog Adjust (Option menu) ....................79
Dialog Lift (Option menu) ..........................79
Dialog Lvl (Option menu) ..........................79
Dialogue
(Audio Signal, Information menu) .......104
Dialogue Adjust (Option menu) ................79
Dialogue Level (Option menu) ..................79
Dialogue Lift (Option menu) ......................79
Dialogue normalization level ...................104
Digital coaxial cable ..................................22
Digital Media Controller (DMC) .................83
Digital optical cable ..................................22
Dimension (Sound Program menu) ...........87
Dimmer (Front Display)
(Display Set, Setup menu) ..................100
Direct (Sound Program menu) ..................87
Display Set (Function, Setup menu) .......100
Distance (Speaker, Setup menu) ..............93
DMC (Digital Media Controller) .................83
DMC Control (Input menu) ........................83
DNS Server .............................................. 98
Dolby Digital EX (Extended surround) ..... 80
Dolby Pro Logic (Surround decoder) ....... 51
Dolby Pro Logic II (Surround decoder) .... 51
Dolby Pro Logic IIx
(Surround decoder) ............................. 51
Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie
(Extended surround) ............................ 80
Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music
(Extended surround) ............................ 80
Drama (Sound program) .......................... 48
DSD ........................................................ 125
DSP Level (Sound Program menu) .......... 86
DSP Program (Front display) ................... 77
DTS Neo:6 (Surround decoder) ............... 51
DTS-ES (Extended surround) ................... 80
Dynamic Range (Sound, Setup menu) .... 94
E
ECO (Setup menu) ................................. 102
ECO Mode (ECO, setup menu) .............. 102
ENHANCER .............................................. 52
Enhancer (Option menu) .......................... 80
ENTERTAINMENT
(Sound program category) .................. 48
Error messages (YPAO) ........................... 43
EX/ES (Extended surround) ..................... 80
EXTD Surround (Option menu) ................ 80
Extended Surround (Option menu) .......... 80
External device control
(Remote control) ................................ 108
External device operation keys
(Remote control) .................................. 13
External power amplifier (Connection) ..... 33
Extra Bass
(Manual setup, Setup menu) ................ 92
F
Firmware update
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 107
Firmware update (on-screen) ................. 111
Firmware version
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 107
Firmware Version
(System, Information menu) ............... 104
FM antenna .............................................. 32
FM Mode (Option menu) .......................... 80
Format (Server) ........................................ 65
Format (USB storage device) ................... 62
Front (Speaker, Setup menu) ................... 91
Front / Rear Balance
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 87
Front display
(Part names and functions) .................. 10
Front display information .......................... 77
Front panel (Part names and functions) ..... 8
Front Presence (Speaker, Setup menu) ... 92
Function (Setup menu) ........................... 100
H
Hall in Munich (Sound program) .............. 49
Hall in Vienna (Sound program) ............... 49
HDMI (Setup menu) ................................. 96
HDMI cable .............................................. 22
HDMI connection (Playback device) ....... 28
HDMI Control .......................................... 124
HDMI Control (HDMI, Setup menu) .......... 96
HDMI Control-compatible TV
(Connection) ........................................ 25
HDMI jack ................................................. 22
HDMI Monitor (Information menu) .......... 104
HDMI OUT
(Audio Output, Setup menu) ................ 97
APPENDIX Index En 132
HDMI OUT1
(Audio Output, Setup menu) .................97
HDMI OUT2
(Audio Output, Setup menu) .................97
HDMI output jack selection .......................45
HDMI video output
(ADVANCED SETUP) ..........................106
Headphones ...............................................8
Height Balance (Sound Program menu) ...87
High definition audio ...............................125
High speed HDMI cable ...........................22
I
Impedance (Speaker) ...............................15
In.Trim (Option menu) ...............................80
Indicator (Part names and functions) ........10
INFO key ...................................................77
Information (Front display) ........................77
Information display ....................................10
Information display
(Radio Data System) .............................55
Information menu ....................................103
INIT (ADVANCED SETUP) ......................106
Initial Delay (Sound Program menu) .........86
Initial setting restoration
(ADVANCED SETUP) ..........................106
Initial Volume (Sound, Setup menu) ..........95
Initial Volume
(Zone2 Set, Setup menu) ....................100
Initialize ...................................................106
Input (Front display) ..................................77
Input menu ................................................81
Input menu item list ...................................81
Input selection keys (Remote control) ......13
Input Trim (Option menu) ..........................80
Internet radio .............................................68
IP Address ................................................98
IP Address (Network, Setup menu) .......... 98
iPad .......................................................... 58
iPhone ...................................................... 58
iTunes ....................................................... 70
L
Language ................................................. 36
Language (Setup menu) .......................... 36
Left / Right Balance
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 87
Level (Sound Program menu) .................. 87
Level (Speaker, Setup menu) ................... 93
LFE ......................................................... 121
Lip sync .................................................. 121
Lipsync (Sound, Setup menu) .................. 94
LIVE/CLUB (Sound program category) .... 49
Liveness (Sound Program menu) ............. 86
Load (Input menu) ................................... 84
Low Frequency Effects .......................... 121
M
MAC Address Filter
(Network, Setup menu) ........................ 98
Main Zone Set
(Multi Zone, Setup menu) ..................... 99
Manual Setup (Speaker, Setup menu) ..... 91
Manual station preset (FM/AM radio) ....... 54
Mass storage class device ...................... 62
Max Volume (Sound, Setup menu) .......... 94
Max Volume
(Zone2 Set, Setup menu) ................... 100
Media sharing .......................................... 65
Memory Guard
(Function, Setup menu) ...................... 102
MON.CHK (ADVANCED SETUP) ........... 106
Monaural Mix (Sound Program menu) ..... 87
Monaural reception mode (FM radio) ...... 53
Monitor check (ADVANCED SETUP) ..... 106
Mono Movie (Sound program) ................. 48
MOVIE (Sound program category) .......... 48
MOVIE THEATER
(Sound program category) ................... 48
Multi measure (YPAO) .............................. 40
Multi Zone (Setup menu) .......................... 99
Multi-zone ................................................. 72
MUSIC (Sound program category) .......... 49
Music Video (Sound program) ................. 48
MUTE key ................................................. 13
Muting ...................................................... 13
N
NAS (Network Attached Storage) ............ 32
NAS (Playback) ........................................ 65
Neo:6 Cinema (Surround decoder) .......... 51
Neo:6 Music (Surround decoder) ............ 51
Network (Information menu) ................... 104
Network (Setup menu) ............................. 98
Network Attached Storage ....................... 32
Network cable .......................................... 32
Network Name (Network, Setup menu) .... 99
Network Standby
(Network, Setup menu) ........................ 98
NTSC
(TV FORMAT, ADVANCED SETUP) ... 106
O
ON SCREEN key ...................................... 13
On-screen menu ...................................... 13
OPTICAL jack ........................................... 22
OPTION key ............................................. 78
Option menu ............................................. 78
Option menu item list ............................... 78
APPENDIX Index En 133
P
PAL
(TV FORMAT, ADVANCED SETUP) ....106
Panorama (Sound Program menu) ...........87
Parametric EQ (Speaker, Setup menu) .....93
PARTY (Multizone function) ......................76
Party mode ................................................76
Party Mode Set
(Multi Zone, Setup menu) ....................100
PC (Connection) ........................................32
PC (Playback) ...........................................65
PHONES jack ..............................................8
Placement (Speaker) ................................15
Playback (iPod) .........................................58
Playback (NAS) .........................................65
Playback (PC) ...........................................65
Playback (USB storage device) ................62
PLII Game (Surround decoder) ................51
PLII Movie (Surround decoder) .................51
PLII Music (Surround decoder) .................51
PLIIx Game (Surround decoder) ...............51
PLIIx Movie (Extended surround) .............80
PLIIx Movie (Surround decoder) ...............51
PLIIx Music (Extended surround) .............80
PLIIx Music (Surround decoder) ...............51
PLIIxMo (Extended surround) ...................80
PLIIxMu (Extended surround) ...................80
Power Amp Assign
(Manual setup, Setup menu) .................91
PRE OUT jack ...........................................33
Presence speakers
(Speaker connection) ............................20
Preset (FM/AM radio) ................................54
Preset (Remote control code) .................109
Preset (TV, Remote control) ....................108
Preset stations (FM/AM radio) ...................54
Pro Logic (Surround decoder) ................. 51
Program Service (Radio Data System) .... 55
Program Type (Radio Data System) ........ 55
PURE DIRECT .......................................... 51
Pure Direct mode ..................................... 51
R
Radio Data System (FM radio) ................. 55
Radio Text (Radio Data System) .............. 55
Rear panel (Part names and functions) ... 11
Recording device (Connection) ............... 33
Remote connection .................................. 34
Remote control
(Part names and functions) .................. 13
Remote control code preset .................. 109
Remote control code preset (TV) ........... 108
Remote Control Code Search ................ 109
Remote control ID
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 106
Remote control ID setting ...................... 106
Remote control sensor ............................... 5
Remote control signal transmitter
(Remote control) .................................. 13
REMOTE ID (ADVANCED SETUP) ......... 106
Remote ID
(System, Information menu) ............... 104
REMOTE IN jack ...................................... 34
REMOTE OUT jack ................................... 34
Rename (Input) ........................................ 82
Rename (Network name) ......................... 99
Rename (Scene) ...................................... 85
Rename/Icon Select (Input menu) ........... 82
Rename/Icon Select (Scene menu) ......... 85
Reset (Remote control) .......................... 110
Resolution (Video Mode, Setup menu) .... 95
Restore of the default settings
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 106
Reverb Delay (Sound Program menu) ..... 87
Reverb Level (Sound Program menu) ...... 87
Reverb Time (Sound Program menu) ...... 86
Roleplaying Game (Sound program) ....... 48
Room Size (Sound Program menu) .......... 86
Router (Connection) ................................. 32
S
Sampling
(Audio Signal, Information menu) ....... 104
Save (Scene menu) .................................. 84
SCENE function ........................................ 46
Scene function ......................................... 46
Scene function configuration ................... 46
SCENE link ............................................... 34
Scene menu ............................................. 83
Scene menu item list ................................ 84
Sci-Fi (Sound program) ............................ 48
Setup menu .............................................. 88
Setup menu item list ................................. 89
Sharing setup ........................................... 65
Short Message
(Display Set, Setup menu) ................. 100
SILENT CINEMA ....................................... 52
Simple play (iPod) .................................... 60
Single measure (YPAO) ........................... 39
SLEEP (Zone2) ......................................... 75
SLEEP key ................................................ 13
Sleep timer ............................................... 13
Sound (Setup menu) ................................ 94
Sound field effect ..................................... 48
Sound mode ............................................. 47
Sound program ........................................ 48
Sound program category ......................... 48
Sound Program menu .............................. 85
Sound Program menu item list ................. 86
SP IMP. (ADVANCED SETUP) .................. 18
APPENDIX Index En 134
Speaker (Setup menu) ..............................91
Speaker connection ..................................19
Speaker connection (Bi-amp) ...................21
Speaker impedance ..................................15
Speaker Impedance
(System, Information menu) ................104
Speaker impedance setting ......................18
Speaker indicator (Front display) ..............10
Speaker placement ...................................15
Spectacle (Sound program) .....................48
Sports (Sound program) ...........................48
Standard (Sound program) .......................48
Standby indicator (Front panel) ..................8
Standby Sync
(HDMI Control, Setup menu) .................97
Standby Through (HDMI, Setup menu) ....97
STEREO (Sound program category) .........49
Stereo pin cable ........................................22
STP network cable ....................................32
STRAIGHT (Sound mode) .........................50
Straight decode ........................................50
Subnet Mask .............................................98
Subwoofer
(Manual setup, Setup menu) .................92
Subwoofer connection ..............................21
Subwoofer Trim (Option menu) .................80
SUR.DEC (Sound mode) ...........................51
SUR.DECODE (Sound mode) ...................51
Surround (Speaker, Setup menu) .............91
Surround Back (Speaker, Setup menu) ....92
Surround Back Initial Delay
(Sound Program menu) .........................86
Surround Back Liveness
(Sound Program menu) .........................86
Surround Back Room Size
(Sound Program menu) .........................86
Surround decoder .................................... 51
Surround Initial Delay
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 86
Surround Liveness
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 86
Surround Room Size
(Sound Program menu) ........................ 86
SW.Trim (Option menu) ............................ 80
System (Information menu) .................... 104
System ID
(System, Information menu) ............... 104
T
Target Zone
(Trigger Output, Setup menu) ............ 101
Test Tone (Speaker, Setup menu) ........... 93
The Bottom Line (Sound program) ........... 49
The Roxy Theatre (Sound program) ......... 49
TONE CONTROL ..................................... 79
Tone Control (Option menu) .................... 79
TP (Traffic Program) ................................. 55
Traffic information .................................... 55
Traffic Program (Option menu) ................ 55
Treble (Option menu) ............................... 79
Trigger function ........................................ 34
Trigger Mode
(Trigger Output, Setup menu) ............ 101
TRIGGER OUT jack .................................. 34
Trigger Output
(Function, Setup menu) ...................... 101
Tuning (FM/AM radio) .............................. 53
TV (Connection) ....................................... 26
TV Audio Input
(HDMI Control, Setup menu) ................ 96
TV connection .......................................... 23
TV FORMAT (ADVANCED SETUP) ........ 106
TV Format
(System, Information menu) ............... 104
TV operation keys (Remote control) ......... 13
TV without HDMI input jacks
(Connection) ........................................ 27
U
UPDATE (ADVANCED SETUP) .............. 107
Update (Firmware) ................................. 111
USB jack ..................................................... 8
USB storage device ................................. 62
V
VERSION (ADVANCED SETUP) ............. 107
Video (Setup menu) ................................. 95
VIDEO AUX jacks ..................................... 31
VIDEO jack ............................................... 22
Video Mode (Option menu) ...................... 80
Video Mode (Video, Setup menu) ............ 95
Video Out (Input menu) ............................ 83
Video pin cable ........................................ 22
Video Signal (Information menu) ............ 104
Video signal type
(ADVANCED SETUP) ......................... 106
Video/audio input jack combination ......... 29
Virtual CINEMA DSP ................................. 50
Virtual Presence Speaker ......................... 50
Volume Interlock (Input menu) ................. 83
Volume Trim (Option menu) ..................... 80
VPS (Virtual Presence Speaker) ............... 50
W
Wall Paper (Display Set, Setup menu) ... 101
Warning messages (YPAO) ..................... 44
Windows Media Player ............................. 65
APPENDIX Index En 135
Y
Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic
Optimizer (YPAO) ..................................37
YPAO
(Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic
Optimizer) .............................................37
YPAO MIC jack .........................................37
YPAO microphone ....................................37
Z
Zone (Information menu) .........................104
Zone Rename
(Main Zone Set, Setup menu) ...............99
Zone Rename
(Zone2 Set, Setup menu) ....................100
Zone2 ........................................................72
Zone2 Set
(Main Zone Set, Setup menu) .............100
© 2012 Yamaha Corporation YE225B0/EN
English
FCC INFORMATION (for US customers)
1 IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT!
This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets
FCC requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by Yamaha may void your
authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product.
2 IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to accessories and/or another product use only
high quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST be used. Follow all
installation instructions. Failure to follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to
use this product in the USA.
3 NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply with the requirements listed in
FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with these requirements
provides a reasonable level of assurance that your use of this product in a residential
environment will not result in harmful interference with other electronic devices.
This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used according to
the instructions found in the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the operation of
other electronic devices.
Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that interference will not occur in all
installations. If this product is found to be the source of interference, which can be determined by
turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the
following measures:
Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by the interference.
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC
line filter/s.
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300
ohm ribbon lead, change the lead-in to coaxial type cable.
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory results, please contact the local retailer
authorized to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the appropriate retailer, please
contact Yamaha Corporation of America A/V Division, USA. 6660 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena
Park, CA 90620.
The above statements apply ONLY to those products distributed by Yamaha Corporation of
America or its subsidiaries.
COMPLIANCE INFORMATION STATEMENT (DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY PROCEDURE)
Responsible Party:
Address:
Telephone:
Type of Equipment
:
Model Name:
Yamaha Corporation of America A/V Division
6660 Orangethorpe Avenue Buena Park, CA 90620
714-522-9011
AV Receiver
RX-A3020/RX-A2020/RX-A1020/RX-A820/RX-A720/
RX-V3073/RX-V2073/RX-V1073/RX-V773/RX-V673/RX-V573/RX-V473/
HTR-7065/HTR-6065/HTR-5065/HTR-4065
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following conditions
:
This device may not cause harmful interference.
This device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
See the Troubleshooting section at the end of the Owner’s Manual on the supplied CD-ROM if
interference to radio reception is suspected.
UC
© 2012 Yamaha Corporation Printed in Malaysia ZD81470
Français
INFORMATION DE LA FCC (pour les clients résidant aux États-Unis)
1 AVIS IMPORTANT : NE PAS APPORTER DE MODIFICATIONS À CET APPAREIL !
Cet appareil est conforme aux exigences de la FCC s’il est installé selon les instructions du
mode d’emploi. Toute modification non approuvée expressément par Yamaha peut invalider
l’autorisation de la FCC d’utiliser cet appareil.
2 IMPORTANT : N’utiliser que des câbles blindés de haute qualité pour le raccordement de
cet appareil à des accessoires et/ou à un autre appareil. Seuls le ou les câbles fournis avec le
produit DOIVENT être utilisés. Suivre les instructions concernant l’installation. Le non
respect des instructions peut invalider l’autorisation, accordée par la FCC, d’utiliser ce
produit aux États-Unis.
3 REMARQUE : Cet appareil a été testé et déclaré conforme aux normes relatives aux
appareils numériques de Classe
«
B
»
,
telles que fixées dans l’Article 15 de la Réglementation
FCC. Ces normes sont destinées à assurer une protection suffisante contre les interférences
nuisibles avec d’autres appareils électroniques dans une installation résidentielle.
Cet équipement génère et utilise des fréquences radio qui, en cas d’installation et d’utilisation
non conformes aux instructions du mode d’emploi, peuvent être à l’origine d’interférences
empêchant d’autres appareils de fonctionner.
Cependant, la conformité à la Réglementation FCC ne garantit pas l’absence d’interférences
dans une installation particulière. Si cet appareil devait produire des interférences, ce qui peut
être déterminé en « ÉTEIGNANT », puis en « RALLUMANT » l’appareil, l’utilisateur est invité
à essayer de corriger le problème d’une des manières suivantes :
Réorienter cet appareil ou le dispositif affecté par les interférences.
Utiliser des prises d’alimentation branchées sur différents circuits (avec interrupteur de circuit ou
fusible) ou installer un ou des filtres pour ligne secteur.
Dans le cas d’interférences radio ou TV, changer de place l’antenne et la réorienter. Si l’antenne
est un conducteur plat de 300 ohms, remplacer ce câble par un câble de type coaxial.
Si ces mesures ne donnent pas les résultats escomptés, prière de contacter le détaillant local
autorisé à commercialiser ce type d’appareil. Si ce n’est pas possible, prière de contacter Yamaha
Corporation of America A/V Division, États-Unis, 6660 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, CA
90620.
Les déclarations précédentes concernent EXCLUSIVEMENT les appareils commercialisés par
Yamaha Corporation of America ou ses filiales.
DÉCLARATION SUR LES INFORMATIONS DE CONFORMITÉ
(PROCÉDURE DE DÉCLARATION DE CONFORMITÉ)
Partie responsable:
Addresse:
Téléphone:
Type d’équipement:
Nom de modèle:
Yamaha Corporation of America A/V Division
6660 Orangethorpe Avenue Buena Park, CA 90620
714-522-9011
Ampli-tuner audio-vidéo
RX-A3020/RX-A2020/RX-A1020/RX-A820/RX-A720/
RX-V3073/RX-V2073/RX-V1073/RX-V773/RX-V673/RX-V573/
RX-V473/
HTR-7065/HTR-6065/HTR-5065/HTR-4065
Cet appareil est conforme à l’article 15 de la réglementation FCC.
Le fonctionnement est soumis aux conditions suivantes:
– Cet appareil ne peut pas causer d’interférences nuisibles.
– Cet appareil doit recevoir toutes les interférences, y compris celles pouvant entraîner des problèmes de
fonctionnement.
Voyez la section Guide de dépannage à la fin de ce mode d’emploi si vous pensez que le problème
de réception radio est dû à des interférences.
AV Receiver
Safety Brochure
Explanation of Graphical Symbols
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is
intended to alert you to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the
product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of
electric shock to persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert you to the
presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the
literature accompanying the appliance.
1 Read these instructions.
2 Keep these instructions.
3 Heed all warnings.
4 Follow all instructions.
5 Do not use this apparatus near water.
6 Clean only with dry cloth.
7 Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
8 Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus
(including amplifiers) that produce heat.
9 Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has
two blades with one wider than the other. A grounding type plug has two blades and a third
grounding prong. The wide blade or the third prong are provided for your safety. If the
provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult an electrician for replacement of the
obsolete outlet.
10 Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched particularly at plugs, convenience
receptacles, and the point where they exit from the apparatus.
11 Only use attachments/accessories specified by the manufacturer.
12 Use only with the cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table specified by the
manufacturer, or sold with the apparatus. When a cart is used, use caution when
moving the cart/apparatus combination to avoid injury from tip-over.
13 Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or when unused for long periods
of time.
14 Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Servicing is required when the apparatus has
been damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been
spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to rain or
moisture, does not operate normally, or has been dropped.
A(Power key)
Turns on the power of this unit or sets it to the standby mode.
For more detailed information, refer to the Owner’s Manual on the CD-ROM. To view the
Owner’s Manual, click on “English” in the screen displayed automatically when you insert the
CD-ROM into your PC, or click on the model name if the screen to select models is displayed,
and then click on “English” in the next screen. Then, follow the onscreen instructions.
If the screen is not displayed automatically, open the “index.html” in the CD-ROM.
Caution: Do not attempt to play this CD-ROM in an audio player.
The Owner’s Manual contained in the CD-ROM can be downloaded from the following website.
http://download.yamaha.com/
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
CAUTION
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
RISK OF ELECTRIC
SHOCK DO NOT OPEN
We Want You Listening For A Lifetime
Yamaha and the Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer Electronics Group
want you to get the most out of your equipment by playing it at a safe level. One
that lets the sound come through loud and clear without annoying blaring or
distortion and, most importantly, without affecting your sensitive hearing. Since
hearing damage from loud sounds is often undetectable until it is too late, Yamaha
and the Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer Electronics Group recommend you to
avoid prolonged exposure from excessive volume levels.
UAB
2En
For U.K. customers
If the socket outlets in the home are not suitable for the plug supplied with this appliance, it should
be cut off and an appropriate 3 pin plug fitted. For details, refer to the instructions described below.
The plug severed from the mains lead must be destroyed, as a plug with bared flexible cord is
hazardous if engaged in a live socket outlet.
Special Instructions for U.K. Model
FOR CANADIAN CUSTOMERS
To prevent electric shock, match wide blade of plug to wide slot and fully insert.
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.
POUR LES CONSOMMATEURS CANADIENS
Pour éviter les chocs électriques, introduire la lame la plus large de la fiche dans la borne
correspondante de la prise et pousser jusqu’au fond. Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est
conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.
Note
IMPORTANT
THE WIRES IN MAINS LEAD ARE COLOURED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE
FOLLOWING CODE:
Blue: NEUTRAL
Brown: LIVE
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this apparatus may not correspond with the
coloured markings identifying the terminals in your plug, proceed as follows:
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the
letter N or coloured BLACK. The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the
terminal which is marked with the letter L or coloured RED.
Making sure that neither core is connected to the earth terminal of the three pin plug.
3En
1 To assure the finest performance, please read this manual carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future reference.
2 Install this sound system in a well ventilated, cool, dry, clean place - away from direct sunlight, heat
sources, vibration, dust, moisture, and/or cold. For proper ventilation, allow the following minimum
clearances.
Top: 30 cm, Rear: 20 cm, Sides: 20 cm
3 Locate this unit away from other electrical appliances, motors, or transformers to avoid humming sounds.
4 Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature changes from cold to hot, and do not locate this unit in
an environment with high humidity (i.e. a room with a humidifier) to prevent condensation inside this
unit, which may cause an electrical shock, fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
5 Avoid installing this unit where foreign object may fall onto this unit and/or this unit may be exposed
to liquid dripping or splashing. On the top of this unit, do not place:
Other components, as they may cause damage and/or discoloration on the surface of this unit.
Burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
Containers with liquid in them, as they may fall and liquid may cause electrical shock to the user
and/or damage to this unit.
6 Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth, curtain, etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation.
If the temperature inside this unit rises, it may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
7 Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all connections are complete.
8 Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may overheat, possibly causing damage.
9 Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords.
10 When disconnecting the power cable from the wall outlet, grasp the plug; do not pull the cable.
11 Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this might damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth.
12 Only voltage specified on this unit must be used. Using this unit with a higher voltage than specified is
dangerous and may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. Yamaha will not be held
responsible for any damage resulting from use of this unit with a voltage other than specified.
13 To prevent damage by lightning, keep the power cable and outdoor antennas disconnected from a wall
outlet or this unit during a lightning storm.
14 Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact qualified Yamaha service personnel when any
service is needed. The cabinet should never be opened for any reasons.
15 When not planning to use this unit for long periods of time (i.e. vacation), disconnect the AC power
plug from the wall outlet.
16 Be sure to refer to the “Troubleshooting” section of the Owner’s Manual on the CD-ROM for
common operating errors before concluding that this unit is faulty.
17 Before moving this unit, press A to set it to standby mode and disconnect the AC power plug from the wall outlet.
18 VOLTAGE SELECTOR (General model)
The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this unit must be set for your local main voltage
BEFORE plugging into the AC wall outlet. Voltages are:
...........................................................................................................AC 110-120/220-240V, 50/60Hz
19 Condensation will form when the surrounding temperature changes suddenly. Disconnect the power
cable from the outlet, then leave this unit alone.
20 When using this unit for a long time, this unit may become warm. Turn the power off, then leave this
unit alone for cooling.
21 Install this unit near the AC outlet and where the AC power plug can be reached easily.
22 The batteries shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as sunshine, fire or the like. When you
dispose of batteries, follow your regional regulations.
23 Excessive sound pressure from earphones and headphones can cause hearing loss.
24 When replacing the batteries, be sure to use batteries of the same type. Danger of explosion may
happen if batteries are incorrectly replaced.
Notes on remote controls and batteries
Do not spill water or other liquids on the remote control.
Do not drop the remote control.
Do not leave or store the remote control in the following conditions:
places of high humidity, such as near a bath
places of high temperatures, such as near a heater or stove
places of extremely low temperatures
dusty places
Insert the battery according to the polarity markings (+ and -).
Change all batteries if you notice the following conditions:
the operation range of the remote control narrows
the transmit indicator does not flash or is dim
If the batteries run out, immediately remove them from the remote control to prevent an explosion or
acid leak.
If you find leaking batteries, discard the batteries immediately, taking care not to touch the leaked
material. If the leaked material comes into contact with your skin or gets into your eyes or mouth, rinse
it away immediately and consult a doctor. Clean the battery compartment thoroughly before installing
new batteries.
Do not use old batteries together with new ones. This may shorten the life of the new batteries or cause
old batteries to leak.
Do not use different types of batteries (such as alkaline and manganese batteries) together. Specification
of batteries may be different even though they look the same.
Before inserting new batteries, wipe the compartment clean.
If the remote control is without batteries for more than 2 minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the
remote control, the contents of the memory may be cleared. In such a case, install new batteries and set
the remote control code.
Dispose of batteries according to your regional regulations.
Keep batteries away from children. If a battery is accidentally swallowed, contact your doctor
immediately.
When not planning to use the remote control for long periods of time, remove the batteries from the
remote control.
Do not charge or disassemble the supplied batteries.
This label is required to be attached to a product of which the temperature of the top cover may hot during
operation.
CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.
This unit is not disconnected from the AC power source as long as it is connected to the wall
outlet, even if this unit itself is turned off by A. This state is called the standby mode. In this
state, this unit is designed to consume a very small quantity of power.
WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT
TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
© 2012 Yamaha Corporation Printed in Malaysia ZD81440
AVEG1A1102C
Information for Users on Collection and Disposal of Old
Equipment and Used Batteries
These symbols on the products, packaging, and/or accompanying documents mean
that used electrical and electronic products and batteries should not be mixed with
general household waste.
For proper treatment, recovery and recycling of old products and used batteries,
please take them to applicable collection points, in accordance with your national
legislation and the Directives 2002/96/EC and 2006/66/EC.
By disposing of these products and batteries correctly, you will help to save
valuable resources and prevent any potential negative effects on human health and
the environment which could otherwise arise from inappropriate waste handling.
For more information about collection and recycling of old products and batteries,
please contact your local municipality, your waste disposal service or the point of
sale where you purchased the items.
[Information on Disposal in other Countries outside the
European Union]
These symbols are only valid in the European Union. If you wish to discard these
items, please contact your local authorities or dealer and ask for the correct method
of disposal.
Note for the battery symbol (bottom two symbol examples):
This symbol might be used in combination with a chemical symbol. In this case it
complies with the requirement set by the Directive for the chemical involved.
IMPORTANT
Please record the serial number of this unit in the space below.
MODEL:
Serial No.:
The serial number is located on the rear of the unit. Retain this Owner's Manual in a safe place
for future reference.
Important Notice:Guarantee Information for customers
in EEA* and Switzerland English
For detailed guarantee information about this Yamaha product, and Pan-EEA* and Switzerland
warranty service, please either visit the website address below (Printable file is available at our
website) or contact the Yamaha representative office for your country. *EEA:European
Economic Area
http://europe.yamaha.com/warranty/
En 1
Supplement for Web Control
You can control the unit with the web control screen displayed in a web browser.
To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the network properly.
Some security software installed on your PC may block the access of the unit to your PC. In these
cases, configure the security software appropriately.
To display the web control screen or turn on the unit from the web control when the unit is in standby
mode, set “Network Standby” (p.3) to “On”.
We recommend using one of the following web browsers.
– Internet Explorer 7.x, 8.x or 9.x
– Safari 5.x
1Start the web browser.
2Enter the IP address of the unit in the address bar of the web
browser.
(Example)
You can check the IP address of the unit in “Network” in the “Information” menu.
You can bookmark the unit’s IP address in the browser or create a shortcut link (p.3) to access the
web control screen quickly in the future.
Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control)
Web browser
Web control
PC Router The unit
Web control
Note
If you are using a DHCP server, the IP address of the unit may change each time the unit is turned on.
If you have enabled the MAC address filter, you need to specify the MAC address of your PC to allow
the PC to access the unit. For information on how to check the MAC address of your PC, refer to its
instruction manual.
Items available on the web control screen vary depending on the model.
En 2
Top menu screen
1CONTROL
Moves to the control screen for the selected zone.
2STATUS
Turns on/off the power for each zone or displays the input source and volume set for each zone.
3SETTINGS
Moves to the settings screen.
4PARTY MOD E
(Not available on some models)
Turns on/off the party mode.
5SYSTEM POWER
Turns on/off the power for all zones.
6MAIN VOLUME
Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the main zone. You can also select the
increments used for volume adjustment.
7RELOAD
Reloads the current status of the unit.
Control screen
1PLAY INFO
Selects an input source or controls playback for the selected zone.
2TOP MENU
Moves to the top menu screen.
3SCENE
Selects a scene for the selected zone (only for the main zone on some models).
4POWER
Turns on/off the power for the selected zone.
5VOLUME
Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the selected zone. You can also select the
increments used for volume adjustment.
6RELOAD
Reloads the current status of the unit.
Multi-zone volume adjustment is not available when an external amplifier is used.
3
4
1
2
5
6
72
14
3
5
6
© 2012 Yamaha Corporation YE224A0/WCEN
Settings screen
1Rename
Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) or the name of each zone. Click “APPLY
to apply the changes to the unit.
IP Address
Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to
the unit.
MAC Filter
Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from the network devices. Click “APPLY” to
apply the changes to the unit.
Auto Reload
Enables/disables automatic reloading. When “Auto Reload” is “On” (enabled), the web control
screen reloads the status of the unit every 5 seconds.
Network Standby
Enables/disables the network standby function.
Backup/Recovery
Creates a backup of the unit’s settings on the PC or restores the settings from the backup.
Firmware Update
Updates the firmware of the unit by using the firmware you have downloaded on the PC.
Follow the on-screen instructions to start the firmware update.
Create Link
Creates a shortcut link to the desired control screen.
Tips
Displays tips for use of the web control.
2BACK
Moves to the top menu screen.
3RELOAD
Reloads the current status of the unit.
2
1
3
Note
Do not operate the unit during the recovery process, as this may result in the incorrect recovery of the
settings. When the recovery finishes, click “OK” to set the unit to standby mode.
The backup does not contain user information (such as user account and password) or unit-specific
information (such as MAC address and IP address).
En 1
This product uses the following free software.
For information (copyright, etc) about each software, read the original sentences stated below.
About ASN.1 object dumping code
ASN.1 object dumping code, copyright Peter Gutmann
<pgut001@cs.auckland.ac.nz>, based on ASN.1 dump
program by David Kemp <dpkemp@missi.ncsc.mil>,
with contributions from various people including
Matthew Hamrick <hamrick@rsa.com>, Bruno Couillard
<bcouillard@chrysalis-its.com>, Hallvard Furuseth
<h.b.furuseth@usit.uio.no>, Geoff Thorpe
<geoff@raas.co.nz>, David Boyce
<d.boyce@isode.com>, John Hughes
<john.hughes@entegrity.com>, Life is hard, and then
you die <ronald@trustpoint.com>, Hans-Olof
Hermansson <hans-olof.hermansson@postnet.se>, Tor
Rustad <Tor.Rustad@bbs.no>, Kjetil Barvik
<kjetil.barvik@bbs.no>, James Sweeny
<jsweeny@us.ibm.com>, and several other people
whose names I've misplaced.
This code grew slowly over time without much design or
planning, with features being tacked on as required.
It's not representative of my normal coding style.
About FLAC codec Library
Copyright ©
2000,2001,2002,2003,2004,2005,2006,2007,2008,2009
Josh Coalson
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with
or without modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are met:
Redistributions of source code must retain the above
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the
names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
About libexpat
Copyright © 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source
Software Center Ltd and Clark Cooper
Copyright © 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Expat
maintainers.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a copy of this software and associated
documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the
Software without restriction, including without limitation
the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish,
distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the
Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission notice
shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of
the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Information about software
English
En 2
About The Independent JPEG
Groups JPEG software
The Independent JPEG Group’s JPEG software
Copyright © 1991-2010, Thomas G. Lane, Guido
Vollbeding.
All Rights Reserved except as specified below.
The authors make NO WARRANTY or representation,
either express or implied, with respect to this software,
its quality, accuracy, merchantability, or fitness for a
particular purpose. This software is provided “AS IS”,
and you, its user, assume the entire risk as to its quality
and accuracy.
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and
distribute this software (or portions thereof) for any
purpose, without fee, subject to these conditions:
(1) If any part of the source code for this software is
distributed, then this README file must be
included, with this copyright and no-warranty notice
unaltered; and any additions, deletions, or changes
to the original files must be clearly indicated in
accompanying documentation.
(2) If only executable code is distributed, then the
accompanying documentation must state that “this
software is based in part on the work of the
Independent JPEG Group”.
(3) Permission for use of this software is granted only if
the user accepts full responsibility for any
undesirable consequences; the authors accept NO
LIABILITY for damages of any kind.
These conditions apply to any software derived from or
based on the IJG code, not just to the unmodified
library. If you use our work, you ought to acknowledge
us.
Permission is NOT granted for the use of any IJG
author's name or company name in advertising or
publicity relating to this software or products derived
from it. This software may be referred to only as “the
Independent JPEG Group’s software”.
We specifically permit and encourage the use of this
software as the basis of commercial products, provided
that all warranty or liability claims are assumed by the
product vendor.
About JsonCpp
Copyright © 2007-2010 Baptiste Lepilleur
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a copy of this software and associated
documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the
Software without restriction, including without limitation
the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish,
distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the
Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission notice
shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of
the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
About Ogg/Vorbis
Copyright © 2002-2008 Xiph.org Foundation
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with
or without modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are met:
Redistributions of source code must retain the above
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the
names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
© 2012 Yamaha Corporation YE161A0/SLEN
About RC4 Algorithm
Copyright Mocana Corp 2003-2005. All Rights
Reserved.
Proprietary and Confidential Material.
About zlib Library
Copyright notice:
© 1995-2010 Jean-loup Gailly and Mark Adler
This software is provided ‘as-is’, without any express or
implied warranty. In no event will the authors be held
liable for any damages arising from the use of this
software.
Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for
any purpose, including commercial applications, and to
alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the following
restrictions:
1. The origin of this software must not be
misrepresented; you must not claim that you wrote
the original software. If you use this software in a
product, an acknowledgment in the product
documentation would be appreciated but is not
required.
2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as
such, and must not be misrepresented as being the
original software.
3. This notice may not be removed or altered from any
source distribution.
Do not disassemble, decompile, or reverse engineer
the software included in Yamaha AV products.
1
TV
A.R. Systems 0320
Acme 0342
Acura 0323, 0343
ADC 0337
Admiral 0054, 0178, 0336, 0337,
0339, 0346, 0347
Advent 0158
Adventura 0057
Adyson 0277, 0282, 0342
Agashi 0277, 0282
Agazi 0337
Aiko 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0342, 0343
Aim 0320
Aiwa 0078, 0379
Akai 0050, 0055, 0109, 0159,
0181, 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0340, 0343, 0349,
0350
Akiba 0320, 0340
Akura 0320, 0323, 0337, 0340
Alaron 0277
Alba 0161, 0277, 0320, 0323,
0340, 0342, 0343, 0344,
0349, 0351, 0372, 0382
Albatron 0140
Alcyon 0171
Alleron 0059
Allorgan 0282
Allstar 0320, 0350
America Action 0179
AMOi 0276
Amplivision 0161, 0282, 0321, 0342
Amstrad 0320, 0323, 0337, 0340,
0343
Amtron 0058
Anam 0179, 0343
Anam National 0052, 0058
Anglo 0323, 0343
Anitech 0171, 0320, 0323, 0337,
0343
Ansonic 0161, 0168, 0320, 0323,
0341, 0343
AOC 0008, 0026, 0050, 0053
Apex 0039, 0111, 0217
Arcam 0277, 0282
Arcam Delta 0342
Aristona 0320, 0349, 0350
Arthur Martin 0321
ASA 0339, 0347
Asberg 0171, 0320, 0350
Astra 0343
Asuka 0277, 0282, 0337, 0340,
0342
Atlantic 0277, 0320, 0342, 0349,
0350
Atori 0323, 0343
Auchan 0321
Audiosonic 0161, 0282, 0320, 0340,
0342, 0343, 0349, 0350
AudioTon 0161, 0282, 0342
Audiovox 0058, 0179, 0194
Ausind 0171
Autovox 0171, 0282, 0337, 0339,
0342
Aventura 0051
Awa 0277, 0282
Axion 0156
Baird 0282
Bang & Olufsen 0180, 0339
Basic Line 0282, 0320, 0323, 0340,
0343, 0350
Bastide 0282, 0342
Baur 0320, 0349
Bazin 0282
Beko 0161, 0269, 0294, 0302,
0311, 0320, 0328, 0351
Belcor 0008
Bell & Howell 0019, 0054
Benq 0097, 0242, 0361
Beon 0320, 0349, 0350
Best 0161
Bestar 0161, 0320, 0350
Binatone 0282, 0342
Blue Sky 0320, 0340
Blue Star 0348
Boots 0282, 0342
BPL 0320, 0348
Bradford 0058, 0179
Brandt 0322, 0345
Brillian 0182
Brinkmann 0320
Brionvega 0320, 0339, 0349, 0350
Britannia 0277, 0282, 0342
Brockwood 0008
Broksonic 0109, 0179
Bruns 0339
BTC 0340
Bush 0269, 0282, 0283, 0304,
0320, 0323, 0328, 0332,
0340, 0343, 0344, 0346,
0348, 0349, 0350, 0372,
0382, 0463, 0470, 0472
byd:sign 0093
Candle 0008, 0026, 0050, 0057
Capsonic 0337
Carena 0320
Carnivale 0050
Carrefour 0344
Carver 0010
Cascade 0320, 0323, 0343
Casio 0367
Cathay 0320, 0349, 0350
CCE 0183, 0282
Celebrity 0055, 0107
Celera 0039
Centurion 0320, 0349, 0350
Century 0339
CGE 0161, 0171
Changhong 0039
Chimei 0273
Cimline 0323, 0343
Citizen 0007, 0008, 0026, 0050,
0058
City 0323, 0343
Clarion 0179
Clarivox 0349
Clatronic 0161, 0171, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0337, 0340, 0342,
0343, 0350, 0351
CMS 0277
CMS Hightec 0282
Coby 0197
Colortyme 0008, 0026
Commercial Solutions
0021
Concerto 0008, 0026
Concorde 0323, 0343
Condor 0161, 0277, 0320, 0323,
0342, 0350, 0351
Contec 0179, 0277, 0323, 0342,
0343, 0344
Contec/Cony 0012, 0058
Continental Edison
0345
Cosmel 0323, 0343
Craig 0058, 0179
Crosley 0010, 0037, 0171, 0339
List of remote control codes
Liste des codes de commande
Liste der Fernbedienungscodes
Lista över fjärrstyrningskoder
Elenco dei codici di telecomando
Lista de códigos de mando a distancia
Lijst met afstandsbedieningscodes
Liste over fjernbetjeningskoder
Liste over fjernkontrollkoder
2
Crown 0058, 0161, 0171, 0179,
0320, 0323, 0343, 0349,
0350, 0351
CS Electronics 0277, 0340, 0342
CTC Clatronic 0341
CTX 0205
Curtis Mathes 0007, 0008, 0010, 0019,
0021, 0026, 0049, 0050,
0178
CXC 0058, 0179
Cybertron 0340
Cytron 0152
Daewoo 0007, 0008, 0026, 0037,
0053, 0167, 0266, 0275,
0277, 0282, 0315, 0320,
0323, 0331, 0335, 0342,
0343, 0350, 0381, 0465
Dainichi 0277, 0340
Dansai 0277, 0282, 0320, 0337,
0349, 0350
Dantax 0161, 0349
Dawa 0320
Daytron 0007, 0008, 0026, 0323,
0343
De Graaf 0346
Decca 0282, 0320, 0342, 0349,
0350
Dell 0145, 0245
Denver 0358, 0362
Desmet 0320, 0349, 0350
Diamant 0320
Diamond 0277
DiamondVision 0135, 0143
Dimensia 0049
Disney 0219
Dixi 0282, 0320, 0323, 0343,
0349, 0350
Dream Vision 0461, 0498
DTS 0323, 0343
Dual 0282, 0320, 0342
Dual-Tec 0342, 0343
Dumont 0008, 0030, 0062, 0282,
0339, 0341, 0342
Durabrand 0031, 0051, 0179, 0215
Dux 0349
Dwin 0178
Dynatron 0320, 0349, 0350
Dynex 0228, 0231
EIZO 0509
Elbe 0161, 0168, 0282, 0320
Elcit 0339
Electa 0348
ELECTRO TECH
0343
Electroband 0055, 0107
Electrograph 0176
Electrohome 0008, 0026, 0052, 0055
Element 0230
Elin 0277, 0320, 0323, 0342,
0349, 0350
Elite 0320, 0340, 0350
Elman 0341
Elta 0277, 0323, 0343
Emerson 0000, 0007, 0008, 0012,
0013, 0019, 0026, 0031,
0037, 0051, 0058, 0059,
0161, 0179, 0320, 0339
Emprex 0154
Envision 0008, 0026, 0050
Epson 0155, 0206, 0359
Erres 0320, 0349, 0350
ESA 0051
ESC 0282
Etron 0343
Eurofeel 0282
Euro-Feel 0337
Euroline 0349
Euroman 0161, 0277, 0282
Euromann 0320, 0337, 0342, 0350
Europhon 0277, 0282, 0320, 0341,
0342, 0350
Expert 0321
Exquisit 0320
Fenner 0323, 0343
Ferguson 0322, 0345, 0349
Fidelity 0277, 0320, 0342, 0346
Filsai 0282
Finlandia 0346
Finlux 0171, 0282, 0320, 0339,
0341, 0342, 0349, 0350
FIRST LINE 0342, 0343, 0350
Firstline 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323
Fisher 0019, 0161, 0282, 0339,
0342, 0344, 0351
Flint 0320, 0350
Formenti 0171, 0277, 0336, 0339,
0342, 0349
Formenti/Phoenix
0277
Fortress 0336, 0339
Fraba 0161, 0320
Friac 0161
Frontech 0282, 0323, 0337, 0343,
0346, 0347
Fujitsu 0059, 0069, 0074, 0075,
0282
Fujitsu General 0282
Fujitsu Siemens 0504, 0505, 0507, 0510,
0511
Funai 0051, 0058, 0059, 0112,
0113, 0115, 0118, 0119,
0179, 0337, 0488, 0489
Futuretech 0058, 0179
Galaxi 0320, 0351
Galaxis 0161, 0320
Gateway 0176, 0177, 0241
GBC 0323, 0343, 0344
GE 0008, 0021, 0023, 0026,
0027, 0031, 0034, 0049,
0052, 0056, 0209
Geant Casino 0321
GEC 0282, 0320, 0342, 0347,
0349, 0350
Geloso 0323, 0343, 0346
General Technic 0323, 0343
Genexxa 0320, 0340, 0347, 0350
GFM 0128, 0227
Giant 0282
Gibralter 0008, 0030, 0050, 0062
GoldHand 0277
Goldline 0320
GoldStar 0007, 0008, 0012, 0026,
0031, 0050, 0053, 0161,
0277, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0342, 0343, 0346, 0349,
0350
Goodmans 0246, 0272, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0337, 0343, 0344,
0349, 0350, 0462, 0473,
0477
Gorenje 0161, 0351
GPM 0340
GPX 0129
Gradiente 0240
Graetz 0347
Granada 0171, 0282, 0320, 0321,
0342, 0344, 0346, 0349,
0350
Grandin 0340, 0343, 0348, 0349
Gronic 0282
Grundig 0160, 0161, 0171, 0310,
0320
Grunpy 0058, 0059, 0179
Haier 0157, 0233
Halifax 0277, 0282, 0337, 0342
Hallmark 0008, 0026, 0031
Hampton 0277, 0282, 0342
Hanseatic 0161, 0168, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0342, 0343, 0344,
0349, 0350
Hantarex 0320, 0323, 0343
Hantor 0320
Harman/Kardon 0010
Harvard 0058, 0179
Harwood 0320, 0323
Havermy 0178
HCM 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337,
0342, 0343, 0348
Hema 0282, 0323
Hewlett Packard 0192
Higashi 0277
HiLine 0320
Hinari 0320, 0323, 0340, 0343,
0344, 0349, 0350
Hisawa 0321, 0340, 0348
Hisense 0247
Hitachi 0008, 0012, 0026, 0066,
0084, 0092, 0093, 0120,
0172, 0173, 0255, 0270,
0271, 0282, 0320, 0335,
0338, 0342, 0344, 0346,
0347, 0365, 0382, 0448,
0456, 0467, 0482, 0484,
0487
Hornyphon 0320, 0350
Hoshai 0340
Huanyu 0277, 0342
Hygashi 0277, 0282, 0342
Hyper 0277, 0282, 0323, 0342,
0343
Hypson 0282, 0320, 0321, 0337,
0342, 0348, 0349, 0350
Hyundai 0141
Iberia 0320
ICE 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0337, 0340, 0342, 0343,
0350
ICeS 0277
Ilo 0148, 0153
IMA 0058
Imperial 0161, 0171, 0320, 0347,
0350, 0351
3
Indiana 0320, 0349, 0350
Infinity 0010
InFocus 0250, 0327, 0363, 0479,
0508
Ingelen 0347
Ingersol 0323, 0343
Initial 0153
Inno Hit 0171, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0340, 0342, 0343, 0349,
0350
Innovation 0337, 0343
Insignia 0131, 0228, 0236, 0238
Inteq 0030
Interactive 0161
Interbuy 0323, 0343
Interfunk 0161, 0320, 0339, 0347,
0349, 0350
International 0277
Intervision 0161, 0282, 0320, 0337,
0341, 0342
Irradio 0171, 0320, 0323, 0340,
0343, 0349, 0350
Isukai 0320, 0340
ITC 0282, 0342
ITS 0277, 0320, 0340, 0348,
0350
ITT 0343, 0347
ITV 0320, 0343, 0349
Janeil 0057
JBL 0010
JC Penney 0007, 0008, 0026, 0027,
0049, 0053, 0056
JCB 0055, 0107
Jensen 0008, 0026
JVC 0012, 0014, 0015, 0056,
0064, 0065, 0067, 0169,
0174, 0297, 0314, 0344,
0350, 0375
Kaisui 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0340, 0342, 0343, 0348
Kamosonic 0342
Kamp 0277, 0342
Kapsch 0347
Karcher 0161, 0320, 0342, 0343,
0349
Kawasho 0008, 0026, 0055, 0277
KEC 0179
Kendo 0161, 0320, 0341, 0346
Kenwood 0008, 0026, 0050
KIC 0282
Kingsley 0277, 0342
KLH 0039
Kloss Novabeam
0057, 0058
Kneissel 0161, 0168, 0320
Kolster 0320, 0350
Konka 0340
Korpel 0320, 0349, 0350
Korting 0161, 0339
Kosmos 0320
Koyoda 0343
KTV 0007, 0050, 0058, 0179,
0183, 0282, 0342
Kyoto 0277, 0282
Lasat 0161
Lenco 0323, 0343
Lenoir 0323, 0342, 0343
Leyco 0320, 0337, 0349, 0350
LG 0031, 0053, 0066, 0116,
0117, 0140, 0161, 0164,
0175, 0195, 0269, 0277,
0282, 0300, 0309, 0317,
0320, 0323, 0328, 0342,
0343, 0346, 0349, 0350,
0366, 0368, 0377, 0466,
0471, 0478
LG/GoldStar 0164
Liesenk 0349
Liesenkotter 0320
Life 0337, 0343
Lifetec 0320, 0323, 0337, 0343
Lloyds 0323
Loewe 0161, 0168, 0265, 0320,
0330, 0352
Loewe Opta 0339, 0349, 0350
Logik 0054
Luma 0320, 0323, 0346, 0349
Lumatron 0282, 0320, 0346, 0349,
0350
Lux May 0350
Luxman 0008, 0026
Luxor 0282, 0342, 0346
LXI 0010, 0019, 0021, 0026,
0027, 0031, 0049, 0111
M Electronic 0342, 0343, 0345, 0347,
0349, 0350
MAG 0096
Magnadyne 0339, 0341, 0349
Magnafon 0171, 0277, 0341, 0342
Magnavox 0008, 0009, 0010, 0013,
0026, 0032, 0033, 0048,
0050, 0128, 0211, 0212,
0224, 0226, 0239
Magnum 0337, 0343
Majestic 0054
Mandor 0337
Manesth 0282, 0320, 0337, 0342,
0349, 0350
Marantz 0008, 0010, 0026, 0050,
0204, 0320, 0349, 0350
Marelli 0339
Mark 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0349, 0350
Masuda 0282
Matsui 0282, 0320, 0323, 0342,
0343, 0344, 0346, 0349,
0350, 0455
Matsushita 0017
Maxent 0147, 0176
Mediator 0320, 0349, 0350
Medion 0320, 0337, 0343
Megapower 0140
Megatron 0026, 0031
MElectronic 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323
Melvox 0321
Memorex 0019, 0026, 0031, 0053,
0054, 0137, 0215, 0323,
0343
Memphis 0323, 0343
Mercury 0320, 0323
Metz 0339
MGA 0008, 0026, 0031, 0050,
0053
Micromaxx 0337, 0343
Microstar 0337, 0343
Midland 0007, 0021, 0023, 0027,
0030, 0056, 0062
Minerva 0171
Minoka 0320, 0350
Mintek 0153
Mitsubishi 0008, 0026, 0031, 0053,
0066, 0084, 0093, 0098,
0150, 0178, 0289, 0320,
0339, 0344, 0350, 0376
Mivar 0161, 0168, 0171, 0277,
0282, 0342
Monivision 0140
Montgomery Ward
0054
Motion 0171
Motorola 0052, 0178
MTC 0008, 0026, 0050, 0053,
0161, 0277
Multi System 0349
Multitech 0058, 0161, 0179, 0183,
0277, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0341, 0342, 0343, 0344,
0346, 0349
Murphy 0277, 0342
NAD 0026, 0031, 0111
Naonis 0346
NEC 0008, 0026, 0050, 0052,
0053, 0072, 0103, 0282,
0344
Neckermann 0161, 0282, 0320, 0339,
0342, 0346, 0349, 0350,
0351
NEI 0320, 0349, 0350
Net-TV 0176
Neufunk 0320, 0323
New Tech 0343, 0350
New World 0340
NewTech 0282, 0320, 0323
Nicamagic 0277, 0342
Nikkai 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0337, 0340, 0342, 0349,
0350
Nikko 0026, 0031, 0050
Nobliko 0171, 0277, 0341, 0342
Nokia 0347
Norcent 0201
Nordic 0282
Nordmende 0339, 0345, 0347, 0350
Nordvision 0349
Novatronic 0320
Oceanic 0321, 0347
Okano 0161, 0320, 0351
Olevia 0102, 0199, 0200, 0207,
0222
ONCEAS 0342
Onwa 0058, 0179
Opera 0320
Oppo 0130
Optimus 0017, 0019
Optoma 0144
Optonica 0178
Orbit 0320, 0350
4
Orion 0043, 0146, 0283, 0320,
0323, 0328, 0343, 0349,
0350
Orline 0320
Osaki 0282, 0320, 0337, 0340,
0342
Oso 0340
Otto Versand 0282, 0320, 0336, 0342,
0344, 0348, 0349, 0350
Pael 0277, 0342
Palladium 0161, 0282, 0320, 0342,
0351
Palsonic 0282
Panama 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0337, 0342, 0343
Panasonic 0016, 0017, 0020, 0022,
0023, 0035, 0052, 0056,
0084, 0085, 0133, 0163,
0193, 0284, 0286, 0290,
0292, 0320, 0325, 0347,
0356, 0483, 0485, 0490
Panavision 0320
Pathe Cinema 0161, 0168, 0277, 0321,
0342
Pausa 0323, 0343
Penney 0021, 0023, 0031, 0050,
0111
Perdio 0277, 0320
Perfekt 0320
Philco 0008, 0009, 0010, 0012,
0026, 0050, 0052, 0053,
0161, 0171, 0320, 0339
Philharmonic 0282, 0342
Philips 0008, 0009, 0010, 0011,
0012, 0032, 0048, 0049,
0052, 0122, 0128, 0134,
0186, 0187, 0213, 0221,
0224, 0226, 0239, 0256,
0257, 0259, 0261, 0263,
0267, 0280, 0281, 0287,
0296, 0299, 0301, 0303,
0305, 0313, 0319, 0320,
0324, 0333, 0339, 0342,
0349, 0350, 0353, 0357,
0360, 0380, 0383, 0452,
0459, 0460
Philips Magnavox
0011, 0032, 0033
Phoenix 0161, 0277, 0320, 0339,
0349, 0350
Phonola 0277, 0320, 0339, 0349,
0350
Pilot 0007, 0008, 0050
Pioneer 0008, 0026, 0094, 0095,
0161, 0320, 0345, 0347,
0349, 0350, 0458, 0480
Plantron 0320, 0323, 0337, 0350
Playsonic 0282
Polaroid 0039, 0142, 0202, 0234
Poppy 0323, 0343
Portland 0007, 0008, 0026, 0053
Prandoni-Prince
0171, 0346
Precision 0282, 0342
Prima 0157, 0243, 0323, 0343,
0347
Princeton 0140
Prism 0023, 0056
Profex 0323, 0343
Profi-Tronic 0320, 0350
Proline 0320, 0350
Proscan 0021, 0027, 0049
Prosonic 0161, 0277, 0282, 0320,
0342, 0349
Protech 0282, 0337, 0341, 0342,
0343, 0349, 0350
Proton 0008, 0012, 0026, 0031
Protron 0196
PROVIEW 0096, 0246
Provision 0320, 0349
Pulsar 0008, 0030, 0062
Pye 0256, 0320, 0349, 0350,
0378
Pymi 0323, 0343
Quandra Vision 0321
Quasar 0017, 0023, 0052, 0056
Quelle 0282, 0320, 0337, 0342,
0349, 0350
Questa 0344
Radialva 0320
RadioShack 0019, 0021, 0031, 0050,
0179, 0320
RadioShack/Realistic
0007, 0008, 0012, 0026,
0049, 0058
Radiola 0282, 0320, 0349, 0350
Radiomarelli 0320, 0339
Radiotone 0161, 0320, 0323, 0350
Rank 0344
RCA 0008, 0021, 0024, 0025,
0026, 0027, 0042, 0049,
0052, 0053, 0063, 0136,
0225
Realistic 0019, 0031, 0050, 0179
Recor 0320
Redstar 0320
Reflex 0320
Revox 0161, 0320, 0349, 0350
Rex 0337, 0346, 0347
RFT 0161, 0168, 0339
Rhapsody 0277
R-Line 0320, 0349, 0350
Roadstar 0323, 0337, 0340, 0343
Robotron 0339
Rowa 0277, 0282
Royal Lux 0161
RTF 0339
Runco 0030, 0050, 0062
Saba 0298, 0322, 0339, 0345,
0347
Saisho 0282, 0323, 0337, 0342,
0343
Salora 0346, 0347
Sambers 0171, 0341
Sampo 0007, 0008, 0026, 0050,
0176
Samsung 0004, 0005, 0006, 0007,
0008, 0012, 0026, 0031,
0036, 0050, 0053, 0076,
0077, 0079, 0114, 0124,
0125, 0126, 0127, 0139,
0161, 0183, 0185, 0190,
0191, 0258, 0264, 0277,
0282, 0320, 0323, 0334,
0337, 0342, 0343, 0349,
0350, 0351, 0373, 0453,
0468
Sandra 0277, 0282, 0342
Sansui 0043, 0109, 0320, 0350
Sanyo 0008, 0019, 0068, 0070,
0071, 0099, 0161, 0168,
0223, 0237, 0277, 0282,
0288, 0295, 0323, 0342,
0344, 0369, 0469
SBR 0320, 0349
Sceptre 0235, 0244
Schaub Lorenz 0347
Schneider 0282, 0316, 0318, 0320,
0333, 0340, 0342, 0349,
0350, 0382
Scotch 0026, 0031
Scott 0008, 0012, 0026, 0031,
0058, 0059, 0149, 0179
Sears 0008, 0010, 0019, 0021,
0026, 0027, 0031, 0049,
0051, 0059, 0111
SEG 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323,
0337, 0341, 0342, 0344,
0349, 0382
SEI 0320
SEI-Sinudyne 0339, 0341, 0347
Seleco 0344, 0346, 0347
Sencora 0323, 0343
Sentra 0323
Serino 0277
Sharp 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003,
0007, 0008, 0012, 0026,
0060, 0088, 0089, 0091,
0138, 0165, 0170, 0178,
0198, 0229, 0262, 0278,
0279, 0291, 0308, 0312,
0336, 0344, 0354, 0370,
0449, 0450, 0451, 0464,
0474, 0476, 0481
Sheng Chia 0178
Shogun 0008
Siarem 0320, 0339, 0341
Sierra 0320, 0350
Siesta 0161
Signature 0054
Silva 0277
Silver 0344
Singer 0321, 0339, 0341
Sinudyne 0320, 0339, 0341, 0349
Skantic 0347
Solavox 0347
Sonitron 0161, 0282
Sonoko 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337,
0342, 0343, 0349, 0350
Sonolor 0321, 0347
Sontec 0161, 0320, 0349, 0350
5
Sony 0038, 0044, 0045, 0047,
0055, 0090, 0104, 0105,
0107, 0110, 0123, 0184,
0220, 0248, 0249, 0251,
0252, 0254, 0326, 0343,
0344, 0371, 0374, 0457,
0475, 0486
Sound & Vision 0340, 0341
Soundesign 0008, 0026, 0031, 0058,
0059, 0179
Soundwave 0320, 0349, 0350
Squareview 0051
SSS 0008, 0058, 0179
Standard 0282, 0320, 0323, 0340,
0342, 0343, 0350
Starlite 0058, 0179, 0320, 0323,
0349
Stenway 0348
Stern 0346, 0347
Strato 0320, 0323
Stylandia 0282
Sunkai 0343
Sunstar 0320, 0323
Sunwood 0320, 0323, 0343, 0350
Superla 0277, 0282, 0342
Superscan 0013, 0178
SuperTech 0277, 0320, 0323
Supra 0323, 0343
Supre-Macy 0057
Supreme 0055, 0107
Susumu 0340
Sutron 0323, 0343
SVA 0151
Sydney 0277, 0282, 0342
Sylvania 0008, 0009, 0010, 0011,
0013, 0026, 0048, 0050,
0051, 0128, 0227, 0253
Symphonic 0051, 0058, 0062, 0128,
0179, 0215
Syntax 0199
Syntax-Brillian 0199
Sysline 0349
Sytong 0277
Tandy 0178, 0282, 0336, 0340,
0342, 0347
Tashiko 0277, 0282, 0342, 0344,
0346
Tatung 0052, 0177, 0282, 0320,
0342, 0349, 0350
TCM 0337, 0343
Teac 0282, 0320
Tec 0282, 0323, 0342, 0343
Technics 0017, 0023, 0056
TechniSat 0274, 0496, 0497, 0499
Techwood 0008, 0023, 0026, 0056
TEDELEX 0282
Teknika 0007, 0008, 0010, 0012,
0026, 0053, 0054, 0058,
0059, 0179
Teleavia 0345
Telecor 0282, 0320
Telefunken 0320, 0322, 0345, 0350
Telegazi 0320
Telemeister 0320
Telesonic 0320
Telestar 0320
Teletech 0320, 0323, 0343, 0349
Teleton 0282, 0342
Televideon 0277
Televiso 0321
Tensai 0282, 0320, 0323, 0340,
0343, 0350
Tesmet 0350
Tevion 0337, 0343
Texet 0277, 0282, 0323, 0342
Thomson 0162, 0188, 0189, 0285,
0320, 0322, 0342, 0345,
0350
Thorn 0320, 0349
TMK 0008, 0026, 0031
TNCi 0030
Tokai 0282, 0320, 0350
Tokyo 0277, 0342
Tomashi 0348
Toshiba 0018, 0019, 0040, 0041,
0046, 0073, 0100, 0103,
0108, 0109, 0111, 0121,
0132, 0166, 0208, 0210,
0214, 0217, 0260, 0268,
0282, 0283, 0293, 0304,
0306, 0307, 0329, 0344,
0355, 0454, 0491
Totevision 0007
Towada 0282, 0347
Trakton 0282
Trans Continens 0282, 0320
Transtec 0277
Trident 0282
Triumph 0320
Uher 0161, 0171, 0320, 0347,
0350
Ultravox 0277, 0320, 0339, 0341,
0342
Unic Line 0320
United 0349
Universum 0161, 0171, 0282, 0320,
0337, 0349, 0350, 0351
Univox 0320
Vector Research 0050
Vestel 0282, 0320, 0346, 0347,
0349, 0350, 0351
Vexa 0320, 0323, 0343, 0349
Victor 0015, 0344, 0350
VIDEOLOGIC 0277
Videologique 0277, 0282, 0340, 0342
VideoSystem 0320, 0350
Videotechnic 0277, 0282
Vidikron 0010
Vidtech 0008, 0026, 0031, 0053
Viewsonic 0176, 0203, 0232, 0364
Viking 0057
Viore 0148
Visiola 0277, 0342
Vision 0282, 0320, 0350
Vizio 0008, 0177, 0218, 0242,
0500, 0501, 0502, 0503,
0506
Vortec 0320, 0349, 0350
Voxson 0171, 0320, 0339, 0346,
0347, 0350
Waltham 0282, 0320, 0342
Wards 0008, 0009, 0010, 0026,
0031, 0048, 0049, 0050,
0053, 0054, 0059
Watson 0320, 0349, 0350
Watt Radio 0277, 0341, 0342
Waycon 0111
Wega 0320, 0339, 0344
Wegavox 0323
Weltblick 0282, 0320, 0349, 0350
Westinghouse 0107, 0216, 0220
White Westinghouse
0037, 0090, 0277, 0320,
0341, 0342, 0349
Wincom 0101, 0106
Xrypton 0320
Yamaha 0008, 0026, 0050, 0053,
0080, 0081, 0082, 0083,
0086, 0087
Yamishi 0282, 0320
Yokan 0320
Yoko 0161, 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0337, 0340, 0342,
0343, 0349, 0350
Yorx 0340
Zanussi 0282, 0346
Zenith 0008, 0028, 0029, 0030,
0031, 0054, 0061, 0062
VCR
ABS 1016
Adventura 1069
Adyson 1008
Aiwa 1024, 1026, 1027, 1069
Akai 1021, 1027
Akiba 1008, 1029
Akura 1008, 1027, 1029
Alba 1008, 1009, 1024, 1025,
1029, 1030
Alienware 1016
Ambassador 1030
American High 1068
Amstrad 1008, 1009, 1026
Anitech 1008, 1029
Apex 1088
ASA 1028, 1031
Asha 1070
Asuka 1008, 1026, 1028, 1029,
1031
Audio Dynamics 1064
Audiosonic 1009
Audiovox 1071
Baird 1009, 1025, 1026, 1027
Bang & Olufsen 1017
Basic Line 1008, 1009, 1024, 1025,
1029, 1030
Baur 1028
Beaumark 1070
Bell & Howell 1065
Bestar 1009, 1025, 1030
Black Panther Line
1009, 1025
Blaupunkt 1028
Bondstec 1008, 1030
Broksonic 1100
6
Bush 1008, 1009, 1024, 1025,
1029, 1049, 1051, 1063,
1217
Calix 1071
Candle 1070, 1071
Canon 1068
Cathay 1009
Catron 1030
CGE 1026, 1027
Cimline 1008, 1024, 1029
CineVision 1104
Citizen 1070, 1071
Clatronic 1008, 1030
Colortyme 1064
Condor 1009, 1025, 1030
Craig 1070, 1071
Crown 1008, 1009, 1025, 1029,
1030
Curtis Mathes 1064, 1068, 1070
Cybernex 1070
CyberPower 1016
Daewoo 1009, 1025, 1030, 1038,
1069, 1223
Dansai 1008, 1009, 1029
Dantax 1024
Daytron 1009, 1025
DBX 1064
De Graaf 1028
Decca 1026, 1027, 1028
Dell 1016
Denko 1008
DiamondVision 1096
DigiFusion 1014
DIRECTV 1019, 1105, 1110, 1111,
1113, 1116, 1122
Dish Network 1018
Dishpro 1018
Dual 1009, 1027, 1028
Dumont 1026, 1028
Durabrand 1114
Dynatech 1069
Echostar 1018
Elbe 1009
Elcatech 1008
Electrohome 1071
Electrophonic 1071
Elsay 1008
Elta 1008, 1009, 1029
Emerson 1008, 1020, 1068, 1069,
1071
ESC 1009, 1025
Etzuko 1008, 1029
Expressvu 1018
Ferguson 1027
Fidelity 1008, 1026
Finlandia 1028
Finlux 1026, 1027, 1028
Firstline 1008, 1024, 1029, 1031
Fisher 1065
Flint 1024
Formenti/Phoenix
1028
Frontech 1030
Fuji 1068
Fujitsu 1026
Funai 1026, 1069
Galaxy 1026
Garrard 1069
Gateway 1016
GBC 1029, 1030
GE 1068, 1070
GEC 1028
Geloso 1029
General 1030
General Technic 1024
GOI 1018
GoldHand 1008, 1029
Goldstar 1026, 1031, 1064, 1071
Goodmans 1008, 1009, 1025, 1026,
1029, 1030, 1031
Gradiente 1069
Graetz 1027
Granada 1028
Grandin 1008, 1009, 1025, 1026,
1029, 1030, 1031
Grundig 1028, 1029
Hanseatic 1009, 1028, 1031
Harley Davidson 1069
Harman/Kardon 1064
Harwood 1008
HCM 1008, 1029
Headquarter 1065
Hewlett Packard 1016
Hinari 1008, 1009, 1024, 1029
Hisawa 1024
Hitachi 1011, 1026, 1027, 1028,
1046, 1062
HNS 1110
Howard Computers
1016
HP 1016
HTS 1018
Hughes 1111, 1113, 1122
Hughes Network Systems
1110, 1116
Humax 1012, 1110, 1113
Hush 1016
Hypson 1008, 1009, 1024, 1029
iBUYPOWER 1016
Impego 1030
Imperial 1026
Inno Hit 1008, 1009, 1025, 1028,
1029, 1030
Innovation 1024
Instant Replay 1068
Interbuy 1008, 1031
Interfunk 1028
Intervision 1009, 1026
Irradio 1008, 1029, 1031
ITT 1027
ITV 1009, 1025, 1031
JC Penney 1064, 1065, 1068, 1070,
1071
JCL 1068
JVC 1007, 1018, 1027, 1039,
1064, 1065, 1066, 1067,
1078, 1089, 1092, 1093,
1094, 1095, 1113, 1208,
1209, 1212, 1213, 1215,
1218
Kaisui 1008, 1029
Karcher 1028
Kendo 1008, 1024, 1025, 1030
Kenwood 1027, 1064, 1065
Kodak 1068, 1071
Korpel 1008, 1029
Kyoto 1008
Lenco 1025
Leyco 1008, 1029
LG 1010, 1026, 1031, 1047,
1054, 1056, 1071, 1103,
1221
Lifetec 1024
Linksys 1016
Lloyd's 1069
Loewe Opta 1028, 1031
Logik 1008, 1029
Lumatron 1009, 1025
Luxor 1008
LXI 1071
M Electronic 1026
Magnavox 1020, 1068, 1114, 1126
Magnin 1071
Manesth 1008, 1029
Marantz 1028, 1064, 1065, 1068
Mark 1009
Marta 1071
Matsui 1024, 1031
Matsushita 1068
Media Center PC
1016
Mediator 1028
Medion 1024
MEI 1068
Memorex 1023, 1026, 1031, 1065,
1068, 1069, 1070, 1071,
1098, 1114
Memphis 1008, 1029
MGN Technology
1070
Micromaxx 1024
Microsoft 1016
Microstar 1024
Migros 1026
Mind 1016
Mitsubishi 1026, 1028, 1079
Motorola 1068
MTC 1070
Multitech 1008, 1026, 1028, 1029,
1030, 1069, 1070
Murphy 1026
NEC 1027, 1064, 1065
Neckermann 1027, 1028
NEI 1028
Nesco 1008, 1029
Nikkai 1008, 1009, 1030
Nikko 1071
Niveus Media 1016
Noblex 1070
Nokia 1009, 1027
Nordmende 1027
Northgate 1016
Oceanic 1026, 1027
Okano 1008, 1009, 1024
Olympus 1068
Optimus 1071
Orion 1023, 1024, 1051, 1115,
1217
Orson 1026
Osaki 1008, 1026, 1029, 1031
Otto Versand 1028
Palladium 1008, 1027, 1029, 1031
7
Panasonic 1000, 1022, 1044, 1055,
1068, 1072, 1085, 1090,
1091, 1120, 1121, 1214
Pathe Marconi 1027
Perdio 1026
Philco 1008, 1068
Philips 1006, 1013, 1028, 1035,
1040, 1045, 1046, 1050,
1058, 1059, 1061, 1068,
1076, 1101, 1110, 1113,
1116, 1117, 1122, 1126,
1210, 1211
Philips Magnavox
1076
Phonola 1028
Pilot 1071
Pioneer 1028, 1036
Polaroid 1088, 1099
Portland 1009, 1025, 1030
Prinz 1026
Profex 1029
Proline 1026
Proscan 1019
Prosonic 1009, 1024
Pulsar 1114
Pye 1028, 1102
Quarter 1065
Quartz 1065
Quasar 1068
Quelle 1026, 1028
Radialva 1008
RadioShack 1071
RadioShack/Realistic
1065, 1068, 1069, 1070,
1071
Radiola 1028
Radix 1071
Randex 1071
RCA 1019, 1068, 1070, 1075,
1110, 1113, 1122, 1125
Realistic 1065, 1068, 1069, 1070,
1071
ReplayTV 1022, 1123
Rex 1027
RFT 1008, 1028, 1030
Ricavision 1016
Roadstar 1008, 1009, 1025, 1029,
1031
Royal 1008
Runco 1114
Saba 1027
Saisho 1024, 1029
Samsung 1002, 1034, 1041, 1043,
1057, 1060, 1070, 1084,
1110, 1116, 1122, 1124,
1220, 1222
Samurai 1008, 1030
Sanky 1114
Sansui 1023, 1027, 1106, 1115
Sanyo 1032, 1065, 1070
Saville 1009
SBR 1028
Schaub Lorenz 1026, 1027
Schneider 1008, 1009, 1024, 1025,
1026, 1028, 1029, 1030,
1031
Sears 1065, 1068, 1071
SEG 1008, 1009, 1029
SEI-Sinudyne 1028
Seleco 1027
Sentra 1008, 1030
Sentron 1008, 1029
Sharp 1003, 1033, 1077, 1107,
1127, 1219
Shintom 1008, 1029
Shivaki 1031
Shogun 1070
Siemens 1031
Silva 1031
Silver 1009
Singer 1068
Sinudyne 1028
Solavox 1030
Sonic Blue 1022, 1123
Sonneclair 1008
Sonoko 1009, 1025
Sontec 1031
Sony 1001, 1016, 1048, 1053,
1073, 1074, 1080, 1081,
1082, 1083, 1108, 1118,
1216
Stack 1016
Stack 9 1016
Standard 1009, 1025
Stern 1009
STS 1068
Sunkai 1024
Sunstar 1026
Suntronic 1026
Sunwood 1008, 1029
Superscan 1020
Sylvania 1020, 1068, 1069, 1102,
1126
Symphonic 1008, 1069, 1126
Systemax 1016
Tagar Systems 1016
Taisho 1024
Tandberg 1009
Tandy 1065
Tashiko 1026, 1071
Tatung 1026, 1027, 1028
TCM 1015, 1024, 1042
Teac 1009, 1069
Tec 1008, 1009, 1030
Technics 1068
Teknika 1068, 1069, 1071
Teleavia 1027
Telefunken 1027
Teletech 1008, 1009
Tenosal 1008, 1029
Tensai 1008, 1026, 1029, 1031
Tevion 1024
Thomson 1005, 1027
Thorn 1027
Tivo 1108, 1110, 1111, 1113,
1117, 1118, 1119, 1122
TMK 1070
Tokai 1008, 1029, 1031
Tonsai 1029
Toshiba 1004, 1016, 1027, 1028,
1037, 1049, 1052, 1086,
1087, 1097, 1109, 1112,
1194
Totevision 1070, 1071
Touch 1016
Towada 1008, 1029
Towika 1008, 1029
TVA 1030
Uher 1031
UltimateTV 1019
Ultravox 1009
Unitech 1070
United Quick Star
1009, 1025
Universum 1026, 1028, 1031
Vector Research 1064
Video Concepts 1064
Videon 1024
Videosonic 1070
Viewsonic 1016
Voodoo 1016
Wards 1068, 1069, 1070, 1071
Weltblick 1031
XR-1000 1068, 1069
Yamaha 1064, 1065
Yamishi 1008, 1029
Yokan 1008, 1029
Yoko 1008, 1029, 1030, 1031
Zenith 1114
ZT Group 1016
DVD
4Kus 2051
Accurian 2142
Advent 2155, 2251
AEG 2362
Airis 2364
Aiwa 2322
Akai 2145, 2177, 2179, 2248
Akura 2356
Alba 2064, 2165, 2186, 2337,
2346
Alco 2149
Alize 2361
Allegro 2133
Amitech 2362
Amphion MediaWorks
2195
AMW 2195, 2363
Apex 2030, 2124, 2125, 2126,
2127, 2130, 2131
Apple 2241
Arrgo 2138
Asono 2364
Aspire 2152, 2222
Astar 2240
ATACOM 2364
Audiovox 2061, 2149
Avious 2367
Awa 2 3 6 3
Axion 2249
Bang & Olufsen 2128
Baze 2367
BBK 2364
Bellagio 2363
Best Buy 2359
Blaupunkt 2131
Blue Parade 2157
Boghe 2382
Brainwave 2362
8
Brandt 2148, 2188
Broksonic 2145, 2146
Bush 2064, 2110, 2170, 2268,
2290, 2346, 2358, 2367,
2383
California Audio Labs
2151
Cambridge Audio
2354
CAT 2352, 2353
CAVS 2192
Centrum 2353
CGV 2354, 2362
Changhong 2140
Cinetec 2363
CineVision 2133, 2237
Clatronic 2358, 2367
Coby 2031, 2046, 2360
Conia 2383
Continental Edison
2363
Crown 2362
C-Tech 2355
Curtis Mathes 2139
CVG 2377
CyberHome 2022, 2098, 2138, 2187,
2336
Cytron 2244
Daenyx 2363
Daewoo 2001, 2133, 2276, 2298,
2330, 2362, 2363, 2377
Daewoo International
2363
Dalton 2357
Dansai 2362, 2381
Daytek 2184, 2195, 2363
Dayton 2363
DEC 2358
Decca 2362
Denon 2059, 2151, 2193, 2332
Denver 2356, 2358, 2360, 2370
Denzel 2380
Desay 2205
Diamond 2354, 2355
DiamondVision 2225, 2232
Disney 2010, 2028
DK Digital 2339
Dmtech 2176
Dual 2380
DUNE 2473
Durabrand 2136
DVX 2355
Easy Home 2359
Eclipse 2354
E-Dem 2364
Electrohome 2362
Elin 2362
Elta 2341, 2361, 2362
Emerson 2129, 2137, 2150
Enterprise 2129
Enzer 2380
Epson 2247
ESA 2137
Finlux 2354, 2362, 2367
Fintec 2377
Fisher 2134
Funai 2137
Gateway 2051
GE 2029, 2131, 2156
Gericom 2351
GFM 2226
Giec 2382
Global Solutions 2355
Global Sphere 2355
Go Video 2133, 2213
Goodmans 2165, 2280, 2291, 2358,
2371, 2376, 2382
GPX 2227
Gradiente 2151
Graetz 2380
Greenhill 2131
Grundig 2349
Grunkel 2362, 2366
GVG 2377
H&B 2358
H_her 2364
Haaz 2354, 2355
Haier 2254
Harman/Kardon 2047, 2135
HiMAX 2359
Hitachi 2062, 2090, 2115, 2274,
2316, 2359, 2380
Hiteker 2130
Home Tech Industries
2364
Hyundai 2366
Ilo 2245
Initial 2131, 2245
Innovation 2182
Insignia 2002, 2137, 2253
Integra 2157
Irradio 2053
iSymphony 2246
JBL 2135
JVC 2020, 2096, 2097, 2099,
2100, 2101, 2102, 2103,
2106, 2107, 2160, 2257,
2260, 2262, 2263, 2321,
2324, 2326, 2327, 2343,
2464, 2465, 2468, 2469,
2471
Jwin 2198
Kansai 2360
Kawasaki 2149
Kennex 2362
Kenwood 2041, 2151, 2348
KeyPlug 2362
Kiiro 2362
Kingavon 2358
Kiss 2380
KLH 2131, 2149
Koda 2358
Koss 2013, 2148, 2158
KXD 2359
Landel 2143
Lasonic 2132
Lawson 2355
Lecson 2381
Lenco 2358, 2362, 2367
Lenoxx 2136, 2153
LG 2002, 2033, 2038, 2057,
2129, 2133, 2189, 2191,
2223, 2238, 2270, 2288,
2335, 2373, 2375
Life 2182
Lifetec 2182
Limit 2355
Liquid Video 2158
Liteon 2043, 2051, 2142
Loewe 2320
LogicLab 2355
Magnavox 2025, 2050, 2137, 2150,
2159, 2224, 2230, 2358
Magnex 2367
Majestic 2360
Marantz 2328
Marquant 2362
Matsui 2148, 2378
McIntosh 2199
Mecotek 2362
Medion 2182
Memorex 2028, 2145, 2234
MiCO 2354, 2382
Micromaxx 2182
Microsoft 2156
Microstar 2182
Minoka 2362
Minowa 2367
Mintek 2131, 2245
Mitsubishi 2003
Mizuda 2358, 2359
Monyka 2380
Mustek 2186
Mx Onda 2354
Mystral 2366
Naiko 2362
Nesa 2131
Neufunk 2380
Nevir 2362
Next Base 2143
Nexxtech 2243
NU-TEC 2383
Onkyo 2159, 2368
Oopla 2051
Oppo 2196, 2255
Optim 2381
Optimus 2180
Orava 2358
Orbit 2363
Orion 2073, 2110
Oritron 2148, 2158
P&B 2358
Pacific 2355
Panasonic 2011, 2024, 2034, 2042,
2058, 2062, 2066, 2067,
2093, 2116, 2117, 2118,
2119, 2120, 2121, 2122,
2123, 2151, 2159, 2164,
2166, 2167, 2172, 2173,
2175, 2209, 2214, 2275,
2277, 2278, 2281, 2282,
2283, 2301, 2374, 2470
Parasound 2197
peeKTON 2364
9
Philips 2008, 2012, 2025, 2044,
2050, 2051, 2053, 2060,
2072, 2108, 2111, 2147,
2159, 2163, 2169, 2174,
2181, 2185, 2230, 2261,
2266, 2267, 2286, 2287,
2289, 2295, 2300, 2302,
2317, 2328, 2338, 2342,
2350, 2467
Phonotrend 2367
Pioneer 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019,
2035, 2092, 2094, 2095,
2109, 2157, 2180, 2190,
2212, 2269, 2272, 2299,
2304, 2305, 2306, 2307,
2308, 2309, 2310, 2311,
2344, 2345, 2347, 2379
Pointer 2362
Polaroid 2125, 2215, 2235
Portland 2362
Powerpoint 2363
Prima 2252
Proceed 2130
Proscan 2156
Prosonic 2360, 2377
Protron 2202
Provision 2358
Pye 2144
Qwestar 2148
Raite 2380
RCA 2021, 2029, 2104, 2105,
2131, 2149, 2156, 2157,
2229
RedStar 2356, 2360, 2362
Regent 2153
Reoc 2355
Rimax 2361
Rio 2133
Roadstar 2331, 2358
Ronin 2363
Rotel 2203
Rowa 2154, 2383
Rownsonic 2353
Saba 2148, 2188
Sabaki 2355
Saivod 2362
Sampo 2141
Samsung 2000, 2045, 2077, 2112,
2113, 2114, 2115, 2151,
2200, 2216, 2219, 2228,
2264, 2265, 2271, 2279,
2294, 2303, 2329, 2365
Sansui 2073, 2145, 2354, 2355,
2362
Sanyo 2134, 2145, 2217, 2292
ScanMagic 2186
Schaub Lorenz 2362
Schneider 2176
Scientific Labs 2355
Scott 2161, 2357
Seeltech 2364
SEG 2161, 2355, 2363, 2380
Sharp 2006, 2040, 2088, 2091,
2182, 2194, 2220, 2221,
2231, 2236, 2293, 2340
Shinsonic 2245
Sigmatek 2359, 2364
Silva 2356
Singer 2354, 2355
Skymaster 2325, 2355
Skyworth 2356
Slim Art 2362
SM Electronic 2355
Sonic Blue 2133
Sontech 2366
Sony 2004, 2005, 2007, 2009,
2014, 2015, 2023, 2026,
2027, 2052, 2068, 2069,
2070, 2071, 2074, 2075,
2084, 2085, 2087, 2168,
2171, 2208, 2210, 2211,
2258, 2273, 2284, 2285,
2312, 2313, 2314, 2315,
2318, 2319, 2466
Soundmaster 2355
Soundmax 2355
Spectra 2363
Spectroniq 2201
Standard 2355
Star Cluster 2355
Starmedia 2358, 2364
Sungale 2204
Sunkai 2362
Superscan 2150
Supervision 2355
Sylvania 2012, 2137, 2150, 2178,
2230, 2239
Symphonic 2108, 2230
Synn 2355
T.D.E. Systems 2366
Tatung 2001, 2362
TCM 2182, 2297
Teac 2149, 2333, 2355, 2383
Tec 2356
Technics 2151
Technika 2362, 2367
Telefunken 2353
Tensai 2362
Tevion 2182, 2355, 2357
Theta Digital 2157
Thomson 2183, 2188, 2334, 2372
Tokai 2356, 2380
Top Suxess 2364
Toshiba 2032, 2036, 2037, 2039,
2048, 2049, 2054, 2055,
2072, 2073, 2076, 2078,
2079, 2086, 2145, 2159,
2218, 2233, 2256, 2259,
2296, 2369, 2472
TRANScontinents
2363, 2367
Transonic 2367
Trio 2362
Trutech 2242
TruVision 2359
TSM 2364
Umax 2361
United 2367
Urban Concepts 2159
US Logic 2245
Venturer 2149
Viewmaster 2364
Vocopro 2206
VocoStar 2207
Waitec 2364
Welltech 2382
Westinghouse 2063, 2250
Wharfedale 2354, 2355
Woxter 2361, 2364
Xbox 2156, 2183
Xlogic 2355, 2362
XMS 2362
Xoro 2382
Yamada 2051, 2361, 2363
Yamaha 2056, 2064, 2065, 2080,
2081, 2082, 2083, 2089,
2118, 2151, 2323
Yamakawa 2363, 2380
Yukai 2186
Zenith 2002, 2129, 2133, 2159,
2223
Blu-ray Disc
Denon 2452, 2500, 2501
Hitachi 2460, 2461, 2463
JVC 2472, 2473, 2475, 2478,
2496, 2499, 2511
LG 2033, 2456, 2457
Marantz (US) 2454, 2455
Mitsubishi 2450, 2451
Onkyo 2504
Panasonic 2011, 2209, 2214, 2476,
2477, 2479
Philips 2510
Pioneer 2212, 2506
Samsung 2045, 2113, 2498
Sharp 2194, 2220, 2221, 2497,
2502, 2503
Sony 2075, 2453, 2458, 2459,
2507
Toshiba 2462
Yamaha 2064, 2448, 2449, 2474,
2505
DVR
Bush 2110
Hitachi 2090
Panasonic 2066, 2067, 2093, 2116,
2117, 2119, 2120, 2122,
2123
Philips 2108, 2111
Pioneer 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019,
2092, 2094, 2095, 2109
RCA 2105
Samsung 2113, 2219
Sharp 2088, 2091
Sony 2084, 2085, 2087
Toshiba 2086, 2218
Victor 2475
Yamaha 2089, 2118
10
DVD Recorder
Aspire 2222
Astar 2240
Broksonic 2146
Go Video 2213
Hitachi 2062
Insignia 2002
Irradio 2053
JVC 2100, 2101, 2106, 2107
LG 2033, 2057, 2223, 2238
Liteon 2043
Panasonic 2011, 2034, 2058, 2062,
2116, 2117, 2119, 2120,
2121, 2123
Philips 2008, 2044, 2050, 2051,
2147
Pioneer 2017, 2035
Pye 2144
Samsung 2000, 2112, 2216
Sansui 2073
Sanyo 2217
Sony 2004, 2005, 2007, 2052,
2068, 2069, 2074, 2208,
2210, 2211
Sylvania 2239
Toshiba 2032, 2036, 2037, 2039,
2049, 2054, 2055, 2076
Yamaha 2056
Cable
ABC 3002, 3003, 3017, 3066,
3067, 3086, 3093, 3119,
3122
ADB 3020
Adelphia 3081
Alcatel 3016
Americast 3124
Amstrad 3022, 3098
Antronix 3065, 3070
Archer 3070
Arcon 3098
AT&T 3095
Axis 3098
Bell South 3124
Cable Vision 3092
Cabletenna 3065
Cabletime 3104
Cableview 3087
Clearmaster 3127
ClearMax 3127
Clyde Cablevision
3105
Colour Voice 3068
Comcast 3084, 3088, 3117
Comcrypt 3107
Comtronics 3069
Contec 3074
Coolmax 3127
COX 3084
Cryptovision 3110
Director 3084
Eastern 3075
Everquest 3123
Fidelity 3098
Filmnet 3107
Filmnet Cablecrypt
3111
Filmnet Comcrypt
3111
Finlux 3097
FIOS 3004
Focus 3126
Foxtel 3022
France Telecom 3100, 3101
Freebox 3023
GC Electronics 3070
GE 3066, 3093
GEC 3105
Gemini 3072, 3123
General Instrument
3017, 3025, 3066, 3084,
3090, 3096, 3117
Goldstar 3120
Gooding 3099
Grundig 3098, 3099
Hamlin 3073, 3078
Hirschmann 3097
Hitachi 3066
HomeChoice 3106
Humax 3021, 3080, 3083
ITT Nokia 3097
Jasco 3123
Jerrold 3017, 3018, 3025, 3066,
3072, 3084, 3090, 3096,
3119, 3123
JVC 3099
Kabel Deutschland
3024, 3027, 3121
Macab 3101
Magnavox 3079
Maspro 3099
Matsui 3099
MegaCable 3117
Memorex 3076, 3122
Minerva 3099
Mnet 3107
Motorola 3025, 3026, 3084, 3088,
3090, 3095, 3117
Movie Time 3077, 3109
Mr Zapp 3101
Multichoice 3107
Multitech 3127
NEC 3064
NET Brazil 3085
Nokia 3097
Noos 3101
NSC 3077
Oak 3074
Pace 3006, 3089, 3121
Palladium 3099
Panasonic 3112, 3118, 3122
Paragon 3122
Philips 3068, 3071, 3079, 3099,
3100, 3101, 3103
Pioneer 3001, 3006, 3094, 3098,
3114, 3116, 3120
Popular Mechanics
3126
Proscan 3066, 3093
Pulsar 3122
PVP Stereo Visual Matrix
3018
Quasar 3122
RadioShack 3123, 3127
RCA 3030, 3031, 3087, 3118
Realistic 3070
Recoton 3126
Regal 3078
Regency 3075
Rembrandt 3066
Runco 3122
Sagem 3101
Samsung 3069, 3089, 3114, 3120
SAT 3098
Scientific Atlanta
3000, 3001, 3002, 3003,
3006, 3028, 3029, 3081,
3086, 3089, 3094, 3095,
3108
Signal 3072, 3123
Signature 3066
Sony 3092, 3125
Sprucer 3118
Standard Component
3115
Starcom 3017, 3072, 3119, 3123
Stargate 3072, 3123
Starquest 3072, 3123
Supercable 3090
Supermax 3127
Tele+1 3107, 3111
TELENET 3007
Telepiu 3107
Thomson 3082, 3091
TIME WARNER
3084
Tocom 3067
Torx 3017
Toshiba 3122
Tristar 3127
Tudi 3102
Tusa 3072, 3123
TV86 3077
Unika 3065, 3070
United Cable 3018, 3119
Universal 3065, 3070
Universum 3097, 3099
V2 3127
Videoway 3019
View Star 3074, 3077, 3079
Viewmaster 3127
Vision 3127
Visiopass 3097, 3100, 3101
Vortex View 3127
Wittenberg 3098
Zenith 3113, 3122, 3124
Zentek 3126
Satellite
AB Sat 4216, 4217
AccessHD 4104
ADB 4220
AGS 4216
Akai 4053, 4055
Alba 4001, 4004, 4006, 4007,
4062, 4217
Aldes 4005, 4007, 4010
Allsat 4048, 4053, 4055
11
Allsonic 4005, 4008, 4024
Alltech 4217
Alpha 4053
Alpha Digital 4104
Alphastar 4077
Amitronica 4217
Amstrad 4011, 4035, 4217, 4218
Anglo 4217
Ankaro 4005, 4008, 4024, 4217
Anttron 4001, 4004
Apollo 4001
Armstrong 4011, 4053
Artec 4100
Asat 4053, 4055
ASLF 4217
Astacom 4216
Astra 4009, 4011, 4054, 4217,
4219
Astro 4004, 4008, 4010, 4015,
4024, 4213, 4218, 4219
AudioTon 4004, 4048
Aurora 4222
Austar 4222
Axiel 4216
Axis 4008, 4009, 4024, 4050
BBK 4205
Best 4008, 4024
Blaupunkt 4015
Blue Sky 4217
Boca 4011, 4054, 4059, 4217
Boston 4216
Brain Wave 4013
Broadcast 4012
Broco 4217
BSkyB 4035, 4041
BT 4216
Bubu Sat 4217
Bush 4006, 4045
Cambridge 4218
Canal Satellite 4213
Canal+ 4213
CaptiveWorks 4099
Channel Master 4007, 4110
Chaparral 4075
CHEROKEE 4216
Chess 4212, 4217
CityCom 4006, 4215, 4219
Clatronic 4013
CNT 4010
Comag 4080, 4081, 4082, 4083,
4086
Commlink 4005
Comtech 4050
Condor 4008, 4024, 4219
Connexions 4014, 4024
Conrad 4024, 4215, 4218, 4219
Conrad Electronic
4217, 4219
Contec 4050
Coolsat 4096
Cosat 4048
Coship 4109
Crown 4011
Daeryung 4014
Daewoo 4057, 4217
DDC 4007
Delega 4007
Dew 4050
Diamond 4051
Digiality 4219
Digital Stream 4105
DIRECTV 4056, 4064, 4067, 4068,
4070, 4071, 4074, 4107,
4116, 4119, 4121, 4122,
4123, 4127, 4192, 4193,
4194, 4195, 4196, 4197,
4198, 4199, 4200, 4201,
4202, 4203, 4206, 4207,
4221
Discoverer 4212
Discovery 4216
Diseqc 4216
Dish Network 4018, 4065, 4089, 4092,
4094, 4095, 4117
Dishpro 4018, 4117
Distrisat 4053
Ditristrad 4048
DNT 4014, 4053, 4055
Drake 4072
DStv 4222
Dune 4024, 4240, 4242
Echostar 4014, 4018, 4065, 4089,
4117, 4217
Einhell 4001, 4005, 4011, 4217,
4218
Elap 4216, 4217
Elekta 4010
Elsat 4217
Elta 4001, 4008, 4024, 4048,
4053, 4055
Emanon 4001
Emme Esse 4008, 4024
Engel 4217
Ep Sat 4006
EURIEULT 4031
Eurodec 4052
Europa 4053, 4218, 4219
Europhon 4219
Eurosat 4011
Eurosky 4008, 4011, 4215, 4218,
4219, 4024
Eurostar 4011, 4215, 4219
Eutelsat 4217
Exator 4001, 4004
Expressvu 4117
Fenner 4024, 4212, 4217
Ferguson 4006, 4052, 4214
Fidelity 4218
Finlandia 4006
Finlux 4006
FinnSat 4050, 4052
Flair Mate 4217
Foxtel 4222
Freecom 4001, 4049, 4218
FTEmaximal 4024, 4217
Fuba 4001, 4008, 4014, 4015,
4024, 4055, 4215
Galaxis 4005, 4008, 4009, 4024,
4048, 4050, 4215, 4222
GE 4066, 4093, 4111, 4197
General Instrument
4019, 4073
GMI 4011
GOI 4117
Goldbox 4213
GoldStar 4049
Goodmans 4002, 4006, 4029
Goodmind 4111
Grandin 4031
Grothusen 4001, 4049
Grundig 4004, 4006, 4015, 4035,
4211, 4218, 4222
Hänsel & Gretel 4219
Hantor 4001, 4013
Hanuri 4010
Hauppauge 4044
Heliocom 4219
Helium 4219
Hinari 4007
Hirschmann 4015, 4024, 4210, 4216,
4218, 4219
Hisawa 4013
Hisense 4016
Hitachi 4006, 4114, 4199, 4203
Homecast 4084, 4085, 4087
Houston 4048
HTS 4117
Hughes 4064, 4068, 4192, 4194,
4196, 4202
Hughes Network Systems
4071
Humax 4025, 4030, 4060, 4097
Huth 4005, 4011, 4012, 4013,
4048, 4050, 4219, 4223
Hypson 4031
Ilo 4016
Imex 4031
Innovation 4008
Insignia 4107
Intertronic 4011
Intervision 4048, 4219
ITT Nokia 4006
Jerrold 4019
Johansson 4013
JOK 4216
JSR 4048
JVC 4029, 4065, 4089, 4117
Kamm 4217
Kathrein 4015, 4034, 4042, 4053,
4055, 4063, 4215, 4216,
4217
Kathrein Eurostar
4215
Klap 4216
Konig 4219
Kosmos 4049
KR 4004
Kreiselmeyer 4015
K-SAT 4217
Kyostar 4001
L&S Electronic 4024
Lasat 4008, 4010, 4024, 4054,
4212, 4215, 4219
Lasonic 4108
Lenco 4001, 4024, 4049, 4215,
4217, 4219
Leng 4013
Lennox 4048
Lenson 4218
Lexus 4053
12
LG 4049, 4103, 4107
Lifesat 4008, 4024, 4212, 4217
Lifetec 4008
Lorenzen 4219
Lorraine 4049
Lupus 4008, 4024
Luxor 4218
Lyonnaise 4052
Macab 4052
Magnavox 4127, 4101
Manata 4031, 4216, 4217
Manhattan 4006, 4010, 4048, 4216
Marantz 4055
Mascom 4010
Maspro 4006, 4217
Matsui 4216
Max 4219
Mediabox 4213
Mediamarkt 4011
Mediasat 4009, 4213, 4218
Medion 4008, 4024, 4217
Medison 4217
Mega 4053, 4055
Memorex 4127
Metronic 4001, 4004, 4005, 4010,
4028, 4031, 4217
Metz 4015
Micro electronic 4217, 4218, 4219
Micro Technology
4217
MicroGem 4106
Micromaxx 4008, 4024
Microstar 4008
Microtec 4217
Minerva 4015
Mitsubishi 4006, 4015, 4202
Mitsumi 4054
Morgan's 4011, 4053, 4054, 4055,
4217
Motorola 4019, 4088, 4090, 4091
Multichoice 4222
Multitec 4212
Muratto 4049
Mysat 4217
Navex 4013
Neuhaus 4009, 4048, 4217, 4218,
4219
Neusat 4217
Next Level 4019
NextWave 4223
Nikko 4011, 4217
Nokia 4006, 4040
Nordmende 4001, 4006, 4007, 4010,
4052
Nova 4222
Novis 4013
Oceanic 4051
Octagon 4001, 4004, 4050
Okano 4011
Optex 4048
Optus 4213, 4222, 4223
Orbitech 4001, 4212, 4213, 4218
OSat 4004
Otto Versand 4015
Pace 4006, 4015, 4035, 4043,
4047, 4204, 4216, 4243
Pacific 4051
Packsat 4216
Palcom 4007
Palladium 4011, 4218
Palsat 4212, 4218
Panasat 4222
Panasonic 4006, 4035, 4036, 4121,
4124, 4126, 4198, 4221
Panda 4006, 4219
Pansat 4125
Patriot 4216
Paysat 4127
PCT 4110
Philco 4101
Philips 4006, 4033, 4053, 4055,
4061, 4068, 4071, 4127,
4196, 4201, 4202, 4203,
4206, 4213, 4216
Phoenix 4050
Phonotrend 4006, 4005, 4048
Pioneer 4046, 4213
Polsat 4052
Predki 4013
Premiere 4048, 4213
Priesner 4011
Primestar 4076
Profile 4216
Promax 4006
Prosat 4005, 4007
Proscan 4066, 4093, 4122, 4197
Protek 4051
Proton 4016
Provision 4010
Quadral 4005, 4007, 4008, 4216,
4024
Quelle 4015, 4215, 4219
Quiero 4052
RadioShack 4019
Radiola 4053, 4055
Radix 4014, 4037
Rainbow 4004
RCA 4066, 4093, 4112, 4113,
4116, 4118, 4119, 4197,
4122, 4207
Realistic 4078
Redpoint 4009
Redstar 4008, 4024
RFT 4005, 4053, 4055
Roadstar 4217
Roch 4031
Rover 4024, 4217
Saba 4010, 4215, 4216, 4219
Sabre 4006
Sagem 4023, 4052
Sakura 4050
Samsung 4000, 4001, 4003, 4032,
4064, 4069, 4071, 4120,
4123, 4196, 4200
SAT 4007, 4218
Sat Cruiser 4223
Sat Partner 4001, 4004, 4010, 4013,
4049, 4218
Sat Team 4217
Satcom 4012, 4219
Satec 4217
Satelco 4024
Satford 4012
Satmaster 4012
Satplus 4212
Schneider 4008, 4212, 4216
Schwaiger 4051, 4212, 4219
SCS 4215
Seemann 4009, 4011, 4014
SEG 4001, 4008, 4013, 4024
Seleco 4048
Servi Sat 4031, 4217
Siemens 4015
Silva 4049
Skantin 4217
Skardin 4009
Skinsat 4218
SKR 4217
Skymaster 4005, 4017, 4022, 4212,
4217
Skymax 4053, 4055
SkySat 4212, 4217, 4218, 4219
Skyvision 4048
SM Electronic 4212, 4217
Smart 4215, 4217
Sony 4067, 4070, 4213
SR 4011, 4054
Star Choice 4019
Starland 4217
Starring 4013
Start Trak 4001
Strong 4001, 4004, 4008, 4024,
4049, 4222
STS 4115
STVI 4031
Sumida 4011
Sunny Sound 4024
Sunsat 4217
Sunstar 4011, 4024, 4054
Supermax 4223
Tandberg 4052
Tandy 4004
Tantec 4006
TCM 4008
Techniland 4012
TechniSat 4014, 4021, 4026, 4027,
4038, 4039, 4053, 4212,
4213, 4218
Technology 4222
Technosat 4223
Technowelt 4219
Teco 4011, 4054
Telanor 4007
Telasat 4215, 4219
Telecom 4217
Telefunken 4001, 4017, 4216
Teleka 4004, 4011, 4014, 4218,
4219
Telemaster 4010
TELENET 4241
Telesat 4219
Telestar 4212, 4213, 4218
Televes 4006, 4218
Telewire 4048
Tempo 4223
Tevion 4008, 4217
Thomson 4006, 4020, 4052, 4058,
4208, 4213, 4215, 4216,
4217, 4219
Thorens 4051
Thorn 4006
Tivax 4104
Tivo 4196
Tokai 4053
Tonna 4006, 4012, 4048, 4217,
4218
Toshiba 4194, 4202, 4203
Triad 4049
Triasat 4218
Triax 4015, 4215, 4217, 4218
Turnsat 4217
Tvonics 4214
Twinner 4031, 4217
UEC 4222
Uher 4212
UltimateTV 4070
Uniden 4079, 4127
Unisat 4011, 4050, 4053
Unitor 4013
Universum 4015, 4215, 4219
US Digital 4016
Variosat 4015
Vega 4024
Ventana 4053, 4055
Viewsat 4098
Visiosat 4013, 4048, 4216, 4217
Voom 4019
Vortec 4001
Welltech 4212
WeTeKom 4212, 4218
Wevasat 4006
Wewa 4006
Winersat 4013
Wisi 4006, 4014, 4015, 4218,
4219
Woorisat 4010
Worldsat 4216
Xrypton 4024
XSat 4217
Zehnder 4008, 4209, 4010, 4215,
4024
Zenith 4102, 4107, 4195
Zodiac 4004
CD
Yamaha 5082, 5095
CD Recorder
Yamaha 5083
MD
Yamaha 5080, 5081, 5086
Tape
Yamaha 5084, 5087
Tuner
Yamaha 5066, 5085, 5088, 5090,
5092
LD
Yamaha 2080
Amplifier
Yamaha 5019, 5020, 5098
Apple TV
Apple 2241
Apple TV” is a trademark or registered mark
of Apple Inc.
© 2012 Yamaha Corporation YE161A0/RC

Navigation menu